blob: d8e1b57f1040c70f23f3a33dfd140efbb64cc07c [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau9dc6b972019-06-16 21:49:47 +02005 version 2.1
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaucb8f03f2019-10-01 18:13:09 +02007 2019/10/01
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020055
564. Proxies
574.1. Proxy keywords matrix
584.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
59
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100605. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200615.1. Bind options
625.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200635.3. Server DNS resolution
645.3.1. Global overview
655.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200677. Using ACLs and fetching samples
687.1. ACL basics
697.1.1. Matching booleans
707.1.2. Matching integers
717.1.3. Matching strings
727.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
737.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
747.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
757.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
767.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200777.3.1. Converters
787.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
797.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
807.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
817.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
827.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200837.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200856. Cache
866.1. Limitation
876.2. Setup
886.2.1. Cache section
896.2.2. Proxy section
90
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200918. Logging
928.1. Log levels
938.2. Log formats
948.2.1. Default log format
958.2.2. TCP log format
968.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100978.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100988.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200998.3. Advanced logging options
1008.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1018.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1028.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1038.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1048.4. Timing events
1058.5. Session state at disconnection
1068.6. Non-printable characters
1078.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1088.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1098.9. Examples of logs
110
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001119. Supported filters
1129.1. Trace
1139.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001149.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001159.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001169.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200117
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020011810. FastCGI applications
11910.1. Setup
12010.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12110.1.2. Proxy section
12210.1.3. Example
12310.2. Default parameters
12410.3. Limitations
125
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126
1271. Quick reminder about HTTP
128----------------------------
129
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100130When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200131fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
132on almost anything found in the contents.
133
134However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
135formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
136correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
137
138
1391.1. The HTTP transaction model
140-------------------------------
141
142The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100143to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100144from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
145connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200146will involve a new connection :
147
148 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
149
150In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
151establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
152by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
153length.
154
155Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
156to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
157however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
158response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
159header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
160
161 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
162
163Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
164power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
165but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200166a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100168Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
170second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
171page :
172
173 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
174
175This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
176latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
177correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
178the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100179server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100181The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
182time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
183are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
184parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
185carry the stream identifier.
186
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100187By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
188connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
189leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100190start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
191processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
192waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200193
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200194HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100195 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
196 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100197 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100198 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200199 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100200
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100201For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
202the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100203server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
204is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
205servers.
206
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207
2081.2. HTTP request
209-----------------
210
211First, let's consider this HTTP request :
212
213 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100214 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
216 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
217 3 User-agent: my small browser
218 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
219 5 Accept: image/png
220
221
2221.2.1. The Request line
223-----------------------
224
225Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
226
227 - a METHOD : GET
228 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
229 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
230
231All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
232which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
233followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
234is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
235desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
236the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
237
238The URI itself can have several forms :
239
240 - A "relative URI" :
241
242 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
243
244 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
245 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
246
247 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
248
249 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
250
251 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
252 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
253 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
254 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
255 must accept this form too.
256
257 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
258 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
259 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100260
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200261 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
262 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
263 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
264 other protocols too.
265
266In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
267mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
268on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
269It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
270specific to the language, framework or application in use.
271
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100272HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100273assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100274However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
275received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
276processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
277as well as in server logs.
278
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200279
2801.2.2. The request headers
281--------------------------
282
283The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
284beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
285an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
286Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
287values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
288encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
289the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
290define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
291
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100292Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200293their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100294"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
295as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200296
297The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
298that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
299is one valid form of empty line.
300
301Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
302headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
303about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
304application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
305
306Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000307 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200308 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
309 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
310 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
311
312
3131.3. HTTP response
314------------------
315
316An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
317messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
318
319 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100320 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200321 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
322 2 Content-length: 350
323 3 Content-Type: text/html
324
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200325As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
326codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
327response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100328continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
329the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
330following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
331sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
332(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
333correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
334such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
335state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
336over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
337if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
338information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200339
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200340
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003411.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200342------------------------
343
344Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
345
346 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
347 - a status code : 200
348 - a reason : OK
349
350The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100351 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
352 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
353 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
354 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
355 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200356
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000357Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100358"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
360messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
361or "Authentication Required".
362
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100363HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200364
365 Code When / reason
366 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
367 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
368 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
369 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100370 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200372 400 for an invalid or too large request
373 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
374 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200375 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200376 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
377 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
378 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
379 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200380 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
382 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
383 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
384
385The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3864.2).
387
388
3891.3.2. The response headers
390---------------------------
391
392Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
393the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
394details.
395
396
3972. Configuring HAProxy
398----------------------
399
4002.1. Configuration file format
401------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200402
403HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
404
405 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
406 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
407 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
408 "frontend" and "backend".
409
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100410The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
411referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100413
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200414
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004152.2. Quoting and escaping
416-------------------------
417
418HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
419many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
420with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
421single quotes.
422
423If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
424them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
425escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
426
427Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
428
429 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
430 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
431 \\ to use a backslash
432 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
433 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
434
435Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
436the interpretation of:
437
438 space as a parameter separator
439 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
440 # hash as a comment start
441
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200442Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
443-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
444backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
445
446Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200447quoting.
448
449Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
450nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
451
452Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
453equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
454
455 Example:
456 # those are equivalents:
457 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
458 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
459 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
460 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
461 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
462
463 # those are equivalents:
464 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
465 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
466 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
467 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
468
469
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004702.3. Environment variables
471--------------------------
472
473HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
474interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
475configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
476optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
477shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
478underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
479
480 Example:
481
482 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
483
484 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
485
486 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
487
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200488Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
489file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200490
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200491* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
492 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
493
494* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
495 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
496 directory.
497
498* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
499
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500500* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200501 processes, separated by semicolons.
502
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500503* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200504 CLI, separated by semicolons.
505
506See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200507
5082.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200509----------------
510
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100511Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100512values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
513otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
514numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
515for every keyword. Supported units are :
516
517 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
518 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
519 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
520 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
521 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
522 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
523
524
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005252.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200526-------------
527
528 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
529 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
530 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
531 global
532 daemon
533 maxconn 256
534
535 defaults
536 mode http
537 timeout connect 5000ms
538 timeout client 50000ms
539 timeout server 50000ms
540
541 frontend http-in
542 bind *:80
543 default_backend servers
544
545 backend servers
546 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
547
548
549 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
550 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
551 global
552 daemon
553 maxconn 256
554
555 defaults
556 mode http
557 timeout connect 5000ms
558 timeout client 50000ms
559 timeout server 50000ms
560
561 listen http-in
562 bind *:80
563 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
564
565
566Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
567
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100568 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200569
570
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005713. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200572--------------------
573
574Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
575are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
576of them have command-line equivalents.
577
578The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
579
580 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200581 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200582 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200583 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200584 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200585 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200586 - description
587 - deviceatlas-json-file
588 - deviceatlas-log-level
589 - deviceatlas-separator
590 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900591 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200592 - gid
593 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100594 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200595 - h1-case-adjust
596 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200597 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200598 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100599 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200600 - lua-load
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200601 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200602 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200603 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200604 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200605 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100606 - presetenv
607 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200608 - uid
609 - ulimit-n
610 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200611 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100612 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200613 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200614 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200615 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200616 - ssl-default-bind-options
617 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200618 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200619 - ssl-default-server-options
620 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100621 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100622 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100623 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100624 - 51degrees-data-file
625 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200626 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200627 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200628 - wurfl-data-file
629 - wurfl-information-list
630 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200631 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100632
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200633 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200634 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200635 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200636 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100637 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100638 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100639 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200640 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200641 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200642 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200643 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200644 - noepoll
645 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000646 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200647 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100648 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300649 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000650 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100651 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200652 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200653 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200654 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000655 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000656 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200657 - tune.buffers.limit
658 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200659 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200660 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100661 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200662 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200663 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200664 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100665 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200666 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200667 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100668 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100669 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100670 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100671 - tune.lua.session-timeout
672 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200673 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100674 - tune.maxaccept
675 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200676 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200677 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200678 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100679 - tune.rcvbuf.client
680 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100681 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200682 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100683 - tune.sndbuf.client
684 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100685 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100686 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200687 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100688 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200689 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200690 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100691 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200692 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100693 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200694 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
695 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
696 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100697 - tune.zlib.memlevel
698 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100699
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200700 * Debugging
701 - debug
702 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200703
704
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007053.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200706------------------------------------
707
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200708ca-base <dir>
709 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200710 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
711 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200712
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200713chroot <jail dir>
714 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
715 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
716 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
717 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
718 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100719 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100720
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100721cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
722 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
723 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
724 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
725 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
726 set. These sets have the format
727
728 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
729
730 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100731 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100732 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
733 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100734 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
735 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100736 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100737 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100738 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100739 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100740 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
741 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
742 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
743 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100744
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100745 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
746 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
747 on the machine's word size.
748
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100749 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100750 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
751 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
752 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
753 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
754 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
755 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100756
757 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100758 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
759
760 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
761 # first 4 CPUs
762
763 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
764 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
765 # word size.
766
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100767 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100768 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100769 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
770 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
771 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
772
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100773 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
774 # and so on.
775 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
776 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
777 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
778
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100779 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100780 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
781 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
782 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
783
784 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
785 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
786 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
787
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100788 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
789 # and a thread range.
790 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
791 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
792 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
793
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200794crt-base <dir>
795 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
796 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
797 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
798
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200799daemon
800 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
801 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100802 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
803 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200804
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200805deviceatlas-json-file <path>
806 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100807 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200808
809deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100810 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200811 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
812
813deviceatlas-separator <char>
814 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
815 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
816
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100817deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200818 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
819 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
820 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100821
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900822external-check
823 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
824 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
825 See "option external-check".
826
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200827gid <number>
828 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
829 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
830 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100831 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
832 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200833 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100834
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100835hard-stop-after <time>
836 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
837
838 Arguments :
839 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
840 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
841 SIGUSR1 signal.
842
843 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
844 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
845 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
846
847 Example:
848 global
849 hard-stop-after 30s
850
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200851h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
852 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
853 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
854 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
855 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
856 ajusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
857 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
858 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
859 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
860 specified in a proxy.
861
862 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
863 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
864 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
865 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
866 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
867 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
868 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
869
870 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
871 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
872 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
873 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
874 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
875
876 Example:
877 global
878 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
879
880 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
881 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
882
883h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
884 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
885 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
886 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
887 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
888 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
889 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
890 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
891 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
892
893 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
894 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
895 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
896
897 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
898 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
899
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200900group <group name>
901 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
902 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100903
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200904log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
905 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100906 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100907 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100908 configured with "log global".
909
910 <address> can be one of:
911
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100912 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100913 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
914 port).
915
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100916 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
917 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
918 port).
919
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100920 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100921 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
922 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100923 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100924
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100925 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
926 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
927 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
928 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
929 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
930 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
931 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
932 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
933 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
934 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
935 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
936 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
937 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
938 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100939 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
940 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100941
942 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
943 "fd@2", see above.
944
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +0200945 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
946 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
947 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
948 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
949 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
950
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200951 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
952 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100953
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200954 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
955 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
956 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
957 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
958 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
959 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
960 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
961 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
962 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
963 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100964 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
965 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200966
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200967 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
968 one of the following :
969
970 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
971 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
972
973 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
974 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
975
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100976 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
977 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
978 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
979 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
980 logger consumes.
981
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100982 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
983 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
984 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
985 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
986
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200987 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
988 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
989 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
990 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
991 set with <sample_size> parameter.
992
993 <sample_size>
994 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
995 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
996 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
997 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
998 (see also <ranges> parameter).
999
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001000 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001001
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001002 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1003 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1004 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1005
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001006 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1007 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1008 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1009 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001010
1011 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001012 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1013 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1014 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1015 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1016 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1017 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001018
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001019 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001020
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001021log-send-hostname [<string>]
1022 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1023 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1024 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1025 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1026 the logs.
1027
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001028log-tag <string>
1029 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1030 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1031 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001032 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001033
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001034lua-load <file>
1035 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1036 used multiple times.
1037
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001038master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001039 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1040 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1041 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001042 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001043 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1044 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001045 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1046 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1047 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1048 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1049 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001050
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001051 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001052
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001053mworker-max-reloads <number>
1054 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001055 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001056 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1057 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1058 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1059
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001060nbproc <number>
1061 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1062 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1063 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001064 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1065 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001066 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1067 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001068
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001069nbthread <number>
1070 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001071 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1072 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1073 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1074 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1075 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001076 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1077 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1078 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1079 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1080 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1081 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1082 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001083
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001084pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001085 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001086 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1087 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1088
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001089presetenv <name> <value>
1090 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1091 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1092 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1093 and "unsetenv".
1094
1095resetenv [<name> ...]
1096 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1097 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1098 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1099 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1100 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1101 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1102 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1103 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1104
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001105stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001106 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1107 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1108 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1109 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1110 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1111 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001112 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001113 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1114 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1115 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1116 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001117
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001118server-state-base <directory>
1119 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001120 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1121 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001122
1123server-state-file <file>
1124 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1125 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1126 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1127 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1128 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1129 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1130 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1131 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001132 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1133 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001134
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001135setenv <name> <value>
1136 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1137 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1138 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1139 and "unsetenv".
1140
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001141set-dumpable
1142 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
1143 developer's request. It has no impact on performance nor stability but will
1144 try hard to re-enable core dumps that were possibly disabled by file size
1145 limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations (ulimit -c), or "dumpability"
1146 of a process after changing its UID/GID (such as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable
1147 on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by the current directory's
1148 permissions (check what directory the file is started from), the chroot
1149 directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily disable the chroot
1150 directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location), or any other
1151 system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are notorious
1152 for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable not even
1153 installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often, simply
1154 writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the issue.
1155 When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to re-appear, it's
1156 often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by issuing, for example,
1157 "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it leaves a core where
1158 expected when dying.
1159
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001160ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1161 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1162 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001163 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001164 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001165 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1166 information and recommendations see e.g.
1167 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1168 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1169 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1170 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001171
1172ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1173 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1174 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1175 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1176 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1177 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001178 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1179 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1180 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001181 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001182
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001183ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1184 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1185 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1186 keyword to see available options.
1187
1188 Example:
1189 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001190 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001191
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001192ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1193 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1194 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001195 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001196 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001197 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1198 information and recommendations see e.g.
1199 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1200 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1201 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1202 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1203 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001204
1205ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1206 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1207 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1208 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1209 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1210 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001211 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1212 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1213 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1214 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001215
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001216ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1217 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1218 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1219 keyword to see available options.
1220
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001221ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1222 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1223 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1224 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001225 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001226 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001227 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1228 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1229 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1230 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001231 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1232 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1233 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1234
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001235ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1236 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1237 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1238 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1239
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001240stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1241 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1242 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1243 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001244 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001245 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001246
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001247 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1248 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1249 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001250
1251stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1252 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1253 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001254 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001255
1256stats maxconn <connections>
1257 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1258 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1259
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001260uid <number>
1261 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1262 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1263 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1264 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1265
1266ulimit-n <number>
1267 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1268 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1269 option.
1270
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001271unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1272 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1273
1274 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1275 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1276 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1277 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1278 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1279 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1280 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1281 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1282 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1283 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1284
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001285unsetenv [<name> ...]
1286 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1287 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1288 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1289 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1290 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1291 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1292 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1293
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001294user <user name>
1295 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1296 See also "uid" and "group".
1297
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001298node <name>
1299 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1300
1301 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1302 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1303 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1304 traffic.
1305
1306description <text>
1307 Add a text that describes the instance.
1308
1309 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1310 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1311 "<" and ">" characters.
1312
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100131351degrees-data-file <file path>
1314 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001315 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001316
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001317 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001318 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1319
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000132051degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001321 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1322 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1323 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1324
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001325 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001326 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1327
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200132851degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001329 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1330 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1331
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001332 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1333 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1334
133551degrees-cache-size <number>
1336 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1337 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1338 By default, this cache is disabled.
1339
1340 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001341 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1342
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001343wurfl-data-file <file path>
1344 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1345 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1346
1347 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1348 with USE_WURFL=1.
1349
1350wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1351 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1352 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1353 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1354
1355 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1356
1357 Valid WURFL properties are:
1358 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1359
1360 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1361 device.
1362
1363 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1364 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1365
1366 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1367 particular web request.
1368
1369 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1370 used Libwurfl API version.
1371
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001372 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1373 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1374
1375 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1376 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1377
1378 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1379
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001380 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1381 with USE_WURFL=1.
1382
1383wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1384 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1385 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1386
1387 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1388 with USE_WURFL=1.
1389
1390wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1391 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1392 thus before the chroot.
1393
1394 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1395 with USE_WURFL=1.
1396
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001397wurfl-cache-size <size>
1398 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1399 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001400 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001401 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001402
1403 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1404 with USE_WURFL=1.
1405
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014063.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001407-----------------------
1408
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001409busy-polling
1410 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1411 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1412 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1413 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1414 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1415 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1416 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1417 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1418 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1419 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1420 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1421 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1422 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1423 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1424 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1425 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1426 "poll" pollers.
1427
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001428max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1429 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1430 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1431 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1432 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1433 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1434 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1435 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1436 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1437
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001438maxconn <number>
1439 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1440 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1441 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001442 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1443 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1444 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1445 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001446 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1447 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1448 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1449 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1450 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1451 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001452
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001453maxconnrate <number>
1454 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1455 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1456 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1457 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1458 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1459 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1460 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1461 fairness.
1462
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001463maxcomprate <number>
1464 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001465 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001466 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1467 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1468 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001469 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001470 default value.
1471
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001472maxcompcpuusage <number>
1473 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1474 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1475 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1476 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1477 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1478 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1479 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1480 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1481
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001482maxpipes <number>
1483 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1484 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1485 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1486 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1487 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1488 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1489
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001490maxsessrate <number>
1491 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1492 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1493 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1494 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1495 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1496 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1497 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1498 fairness.
1499
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001500maxsslconn <number>
1501 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1502 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1503 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1504 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1505 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1506 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1507 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001508 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1509 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1510 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1511 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1512 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1513 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1514 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001515
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001516maxsslrate <number>
1517 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1518 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1519 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1520 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1521 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1522 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1523 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1524 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1525 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1526 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1527
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001528maxzlibmem <number>
1529 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1530 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1531 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001532 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1533 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1534 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1535
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001536noepoll
1537 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1538 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001539 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001540
1541nokqueue
1542 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1543 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1544 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1545
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001546noevports
1547 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1548 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1549 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1550 also "nopoll".
1551
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001552nopoll
1553 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1554 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001555 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001556 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1557 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001558
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001559nosplice
1560 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001561 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001562 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001563 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001564 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1565 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1566 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1567 "option splice-response".
1568
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001569nogetaddrinfo
1570 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1571 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1572
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001573noreuseport
1574 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1575 command line argument "-dR".
1576
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001577profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1578 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1579 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1580 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1581 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001582 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001583 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1584 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1585 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1586 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1587
1588 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1589 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1590 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1591 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1592 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001593 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1594 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1595 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1596 CLI.
1597
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001598spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001599 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1600 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1601 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1602 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1603 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1604 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001605
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001606ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001607 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001608 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001609 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1610 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1611 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1612 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1613 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001614 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1615 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001616 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1617 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1618 openssl configuration file uses:
1619 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1620
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001621ssl-mode-async
1622 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001623 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001624 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1625 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1626 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001627 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001628 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001629
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001630tune.buffers.limit <number>
1631 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1632 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1633 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1634 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1635 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001636 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001637 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1638 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1639 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1640 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1641 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1642 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1643 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1644 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1645 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1646
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001647tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1648 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1649 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1650 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1651 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1652
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001653tune.bufsize <number>
1654 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1655 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1656 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1657 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1658 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1659 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1660 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001661 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1662 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1663 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001664 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001665 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1666 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1667 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001668
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001669tune.chksize <number>
1670 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1671 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1672 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1673 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1674 checks whenever possible.
1675
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001676tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1677 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1678 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1679 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1680 this value. The default value is 1.
1681
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001682tune.fail-alloc
1683 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1684 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1685 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1686 gracefully.
1687
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001688tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1689 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1690 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1691 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1692 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1693 change it.
1694
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001695tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1696 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001697 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1698 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001699 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1700 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1701 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1702 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1703 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1704
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001705tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1706 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1707 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1708 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1709 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1710 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1711 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1712 recommended not to change this value.
1713
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001714tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1715 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1716 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1717 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1718 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1719 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1720 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1721 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1722
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001723tune.http.cookielen <number>
1724 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1725 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1726 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1727 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1728 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1729 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1730 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1731 to change this value.
1732
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001733tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001734 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1735 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001736 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001737 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001738 configuration directives too.
1739 The default value is 1024.
1740
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001741tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1742 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1743 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1744 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1745 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1746 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1747 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001748 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1749 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1750 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001751
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001752tune.idletimer <timeout>
1753 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1754 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1755 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1756 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1757 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1758 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001759 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001760 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001761 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1762
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001763tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1764 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1765 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1766 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1767 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1768 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1769 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1770 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1771 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1772 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1773
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001774tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1775 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001776 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001777 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1778 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001779 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001780 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1781 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1782
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001783tune.lua.maxmem
1784 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1785 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1786 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1787 memory.
1788
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001789tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1790 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001791 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1792 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001793 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001794
1795tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1796 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1797 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1798 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1799 check servers.
1800
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001801tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1802 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1803 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1804 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001805 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001806
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001807tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001808 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1809 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1810 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1811 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1812 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1813 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1814 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1815 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1816 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1817 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001818
1819tune.maxpollevents <number>
1820 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1821 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1822 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1823 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1824 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1825
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001826tune.maxrewrite <number>
1827 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1828 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1829 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1830 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1831 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1832 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1833 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1834 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1835 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1836 bufsize.
1837
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001838tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1839 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1840 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1841 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1842 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1843 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1844 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1845 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1846 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1847 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02001848 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
1849 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001850 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1851 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1852 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1853 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1854 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1855 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1856 setting this parameter to 0.
1857
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001858tune.pipesize <number>
1859 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1860 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1861 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1862 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1863 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1864 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1865
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001866tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
1867 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1868 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1869 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
1870 default is 20.
1871
1872tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
1873 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1874 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1875 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
1876 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
1877 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
1878 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001879 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001880
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001881tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1882tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1883 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1884 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1885 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001886 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001887 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001888 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1889 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1890
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001891tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001892 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001893 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1894 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1895 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1896 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1897
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001898tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001899 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001900 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1901 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1902
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001903tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1904tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1905 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1906 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1907 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001908 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001909 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001910 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1911 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1912 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1913 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1914 notifying haproxy again.
1915
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001916tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001917 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1918 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1919 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001920 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001921 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001922 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001923 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1924 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1925 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001926 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1927 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001928
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001929tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001930 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001931 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1932 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1933 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1934 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1935 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1936
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001937tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1938 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001939 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001940 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1941 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1942 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1943 being used for too long.
1944
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001945tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1946 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1947 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1948 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1949 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1950 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1951 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1952 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1953 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1954 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1955 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001956 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001957 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001958
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001959tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1960 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1961 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1962 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1963 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1964 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1965 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1966 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001967 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1968 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001969
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001970tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1971 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1972 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1973 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1974 1000 entries.
1975
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001976tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1977 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1978 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1979 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1980
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001981tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001982tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001983tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1984tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1985tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001986 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1987 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1988 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1989 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1990 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1991 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1992 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1993 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001994
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001995 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1996 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1997 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1998 all available space is consumed.
1999 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2000 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2001 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002002
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002003tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2004 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002005 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002006 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002007 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002008 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2009
2010tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2011 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2012 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002013 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2014 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020163.3. Debugging
2017--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002018
2019debug
2020 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2021 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2022 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2023 system startup.
2024
2025quiet
2026 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2027 line argument "-q".
2028
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002029
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020303.4. Userlists
2031--------------
2032It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2033http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2034it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2035
2036userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002037 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002038 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2039
2040group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002041 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002042 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2043 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2044
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002045user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2046 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002047 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2048 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002049 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2050 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2051 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2052 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002053
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002054 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2055 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2056 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2057 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2058 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2059 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2060 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2061 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2062 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002063
2064 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002065 userlist L1
2066 group G1 users tiger,scott
2067 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002068
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002069 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2070 user scott insecure-password elgato
2071 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002072
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002073 userlist L2
2074 group G1
2075 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002076
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002077 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2078 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2079 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002080
2081 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002082
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002083
20843.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002085----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002086It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2087several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2088instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2089values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2090automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2091In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2092using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2093tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2094reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2095Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2096that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2097each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002098
2099peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002100 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002101 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2102
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002103bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2104 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2105 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2106
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002107disabled
2108 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2109 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2110 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2111
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002112default-bind [param*]
2113 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2114
2115default-server [param*]
2116 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2117
2118 Arguments:
2119 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2120 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2121 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2122 details.
2123
2124
2125 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2126
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002127enable
2128 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2129
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002130peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002131 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2132 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2133 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2134 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2135 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2136 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2137
2138 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2139 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2140
2141 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2142 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2143 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2144 across all peers.
2145
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002146 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2147 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002148
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002149 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2150 "server" keyword explanation below).
2151
2152server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002153 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002154 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2155 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2156 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2157 of this "peers" section).
2158 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2159
2160
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002161 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002162 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002163 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002164 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2165 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2166 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002167
2168 backend mybackend
2169 mode tcp
2170 balance roundrobin
2171 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2172 stick on src
2173
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002174 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2175 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002176
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002177 Example:
2178 peers mypeers
2179 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2180 default-server ssl verify none
2181 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2182 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002183
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002184
2185table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2186 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2187
2188 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2189 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002190 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002191 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2192 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2193 "stick-table" keyword).
2194
2195 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2196 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2197 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2198 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2199 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2200 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2201 of the stick-table name as follows:
2202
2203 peers mypeers
2204 peer A ...
2205 peer B ...
2206 table t1 ...
2207
2208 frontend fe1
2209 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2210
2211 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2212 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2213
2214 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2215 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2216 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2217 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2218 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2219 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2220 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2221
2222 peers mypeers
2223 peer A ...
2224 peer B ...
2225 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2226
2227 backend t1
2228 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2229
2230 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2231 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2232 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2233
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090022343.6. Mailers
2235------------
2236It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2237If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2238in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2239
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002240mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002241 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2242 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2243
2244mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2245 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2246
2247 Example:
2248 mailers mymailers
2249 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2250 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2251
2252 backend mybackend
2253 mode tcp
2254 balance roundrobin
2255
2256 email-alert mailers mymailers
2257 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2258 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2259
2260 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2261 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2262
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002263timeout mail <time>
2264 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2265 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2266 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2267 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2268
2269 Example:
2270 mailers mymailers
2271 timeout mail 20s
2272 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002273
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020022743.7. Programs
2275-------------
2276In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2277master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2278managed the same way as the workers.
2279
2280During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2281sequence as a worker:
2282
2283 - the master is re-executed
2284 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2285 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2286 instance of the program
2287
2288During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2289
2290program <name>
2291 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2292 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2293 the management guide).
2294
2295command <command> [arguments*]
2296 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2297 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2298 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2299 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2300
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002301user <user name>
2302 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2303 See also "group".
2304
2305group <group name>
2306 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2307 See also "user".
2308
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002309option start-on-reload
2310no option start-on-reload
2311 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2312 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2313 program section.
2314
2315
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023164. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002317----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002318
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002319Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002320 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002321 - frontend <name>
2322 - backend <name>
2323 - listen <name>
2324
2325A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2326its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2327section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002328section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002329
2330A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2331connections.
2332
2333A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2334to forward incoming connections.
2335
2336A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2337parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2338
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002339All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2340'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2341case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2342
2343Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2344logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2345proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2346However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2347name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2348
2349Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2350and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002351bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002352protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2353modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2354arbitrary criteria.
2355
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002356In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2357a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002358the backend's. HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002359
2360 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2361 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2362 between responses and new requests.
2363
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002364 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2365 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2366 client-facing connection remains open.
2367
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002368 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2369 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002370
2371The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2372frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2373following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002374weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002375
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002376 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002377
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002378 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2379 ----+-----+-----+----
2380 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2381 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002382 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2383 ----+-----+-----+----
2384 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002385
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002386
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002387
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023884.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2389--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002390
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002391The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2392limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2393they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2394limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002395marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002396option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002397and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2398with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2399specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002400
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002401
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002402 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2403------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2404acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002405backlog X X X -
2406balance X - X X
2407bind - X X -
2408bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002409capture cookie - X X -
2410capture request header - X X -
2411capture response header - X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002412compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002413cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002414declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002415default-server X - X X
2416default_backend X X X -
2417description - X X X
2418disabled X X X X
2419dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002420email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002421email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002422email-alert mailers X X X X
2423email-alert myhostname X X X X
2424email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002425enabled X X X X
2426errorfile X X X X
2427errorloc X X X X
2428errorloc302 X X X X
2429-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2430errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002431force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002432filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002433fullconn X - X X
2434grace X X X X
2435hash-type X - X X
2436http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002437http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002438http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002439http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002440http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002441http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002442http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002443id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002444ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002445load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002446log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002447log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002448log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002449log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002450max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002451maxconn X X X -
2452mode X X X X
2453monitor fail - X X -
2454monitor-net X X X -
2455monitor-uri X X X -
2456option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2457option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2458option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2459option allbackups (*) X - X X
2460option checkcache (*) X - X X
2461option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2462option contstats (*) X X X -
2463option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2464option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002465-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2466option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002467option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2468option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002469option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002470option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002471option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002472option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002473option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002474option http-server-close (*) X X X X
2475option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2476option httpchk X - X X
2477option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002478option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002479option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002480option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002481option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002482option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002483option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2484option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2485option logasap (*) X X X -
2486option mysql-check X - X X
2487option nolinger (*) X X X X
2488option originalto X X X X
2489option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002490option pgsql-check X - X X
2491option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002492option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002493option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002494option smtpchk X - X X
2495option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2496option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2497option splice-request (*) X X X X
2498option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002499option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002500option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2501option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2502-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002503option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002504option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2505option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2506option tcpka X X X X
2507option tcplog X X X X
2508option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002509external-check command X - X X
2510external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002511persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2512rate-limit sessions X X X -
2513redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002514-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002515retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002516retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002517server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002518server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002519server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002520source X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002521stats admin - X X X
2522stats auth X X X X
2523stats enable X X X X
2524stats hide-version X X X X
2525stats http-request - X X X
2526stats realm X X X X
2527stats refresh X X X X
2528stats scope X X X X
2529stats show-desc X X X X
2530stats show-legends X X X X
2531stats show-node X X X X
2532stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002533-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2534stick match - - X X
2535stick on - - X X
2536stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002537stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002538stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002539tcp-check connect - - X X
2540tcp-check expect - - X X
2541tcp-check send - - X X
2542tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002543tcp-request connection - X X -
2544tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002545tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002546tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002547tcp-response content - - X X
2548tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002549timeout check X - X X
2550timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002551timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002552timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002553timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2554timeout http-request X X X X
2555timeout queue X - X X
2556timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002557timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002558timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002559timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002560transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002561unique-id-format X X X -
2562unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002563use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002564use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002565use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002566------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2567 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002568
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002569
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025704.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2571---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002572
2573This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2574
2575
2576acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2577 Declare or complete an access list.
2578 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2579 no | yes | yes | yes
2580 Example:
2581 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2582 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2583 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2584
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002585 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002586
2587
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002588backlog <conns>
2589 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2590 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2591 yes | yes | yes | no
2592 Arguments :
2593 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2594 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002595 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002596
2597 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2598 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2599 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2600 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2601 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2602 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2603 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2604 backlog parameter.
2605
2606 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2607 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2608 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2609
2610 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2611
2612
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002613balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002614balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002615 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2616 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2617 yes | no | yes | yes
2618 Arguments :
2619 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2620 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2621 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2622 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2623
2624 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2625 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2626 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2627 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002628 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002629 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002630 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2631 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2632 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2633 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2634 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2635 it, so that you don't worry.
2636
2637 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2638 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2639 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2640 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2641 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2642 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2643 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2644 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002645
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002646 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2647 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2648 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2649 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2650 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2651 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2652 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2653 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2654
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002655 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002656 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002657 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2658 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002659 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002660 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2661 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2662 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2663 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2664 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002665 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2666 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2667 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2668 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2669 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2670 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002671
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002672 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2673 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2674 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2675 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2676 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2677 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2678 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2679 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002680 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002681 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002682 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2683 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2684 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002685
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002686 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2687 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2688 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2689 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2690 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2691 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2692 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2693 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2694 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2695 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2696 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2697 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002698
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002699 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002700 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2701 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2702 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2703 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2704 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2705 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2706 URIs start with a leading "/".
2707
2708 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2709 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2710 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2711 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2712
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002713 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002714 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2715
2716 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002717 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2718 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002719 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2720 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2721 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2722 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002723 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002724 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2725 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002726
2727 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2728 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2729 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2730 server will receive the request.
2731
2732 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2733 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2734 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2735 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2736 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002737 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2738 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2739 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002740
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002741 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2742 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2743 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2744 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2745 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002746
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002747 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002748 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2749 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2750 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2751
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002752 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2753 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2754 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2755
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002756 random
2757 random(<draws>)
2758 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002759 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2760 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2761 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2762 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002763 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2764 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2765 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2766 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2767 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2768 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2769 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2770 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2771 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2772 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2773 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2774 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2775 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2776 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2777 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2778 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2779 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2780 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2781 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2782 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002783
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002784 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002785 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002786 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2787 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2788 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2789 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2790 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2791 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002792 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002793 used instead.
2794
2795 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2796 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2797 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2798 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2799
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002800 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2801 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2802 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2803
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002804 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002805
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002806 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002807 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2808 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002809
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002810 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2811 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2812 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002813
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002814 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002815 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002816 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2817 NTLM relies on.
2818
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002819 Examples :
2820 balance roundrobin
2821 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002822 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002823 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2824 balance hdr(host)
2825 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002826
2827 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2828 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2829
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002830 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002831 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2832 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2833 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02002834 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002835
2836 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2837 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2838 defaults to 16 kB.
2839
2840 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2841 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2842
2843 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2844 Round Robin.
2845
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002846 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002847 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2848 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2849 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2850
2851 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2852
2853 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002854 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002855 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2856 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2857 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002858
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002859 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002860
2861
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002862bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2863bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002864 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2865 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2866 no | yes | yes | no
2867 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002868 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2869 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2870 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2871 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002872 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002873 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2874 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2875 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2876 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2877 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2878 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2879 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002880 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2881 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2882 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2883 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2884 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2885 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2886 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002887 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2888 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2889 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002890 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2891 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2892 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2893 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002894 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2895 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2896 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002897
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002898 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2899 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002900 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2901 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2902 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002903 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2904 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2905 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2906 the range.
2907
2908 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2909 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2910 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2911 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2912 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2913 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2914 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002915 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002916 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002917
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002918 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002919 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002920 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2921 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2922 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2923 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2924 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2925 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2926
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002927 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2928 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2929 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2930 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002931
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002932 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2933 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2934 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2935 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2936 in a frontend.
2937
2938 Example :
2939 listen http_proxy
2940 bind :80,:443
2941 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002942 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002943
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002944 listen http_https_proxy
2945 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002946 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002947
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002948 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2949 bind ipv6@:80
2950 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2951 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2952
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002953 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002954 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002955
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002956 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2957 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2958 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2959 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2960 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2961
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002962 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002963 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002964
2965
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002966bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002967 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2968 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2969 yes | yes | yes | yes
2970 Arguments :
2971 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2972 may be used to override a default value.
2973
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002974 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002975 option may be combined with other numbers.
2976
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002977 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002978 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2979 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2980 missing from all processes.
2981
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002982 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002983 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002984 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
2985 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
2986 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
2987 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
2988 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002989 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002990
2991 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2992 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2993 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2994 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2995 and 'even' instances.
2996
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002997 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2998 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2999 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3000 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003001
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003002 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3003 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3004
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003005 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3006 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3007 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3008
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003009 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3010 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3011
3012 Example :
3013 listen app_ip1
3014 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003015 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003016
3017 listen app_ip2
3018 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003019 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003020
3021 listen management
3022 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003023 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003024
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003025 listen management
3026 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3027 bind-process 1-4
3028
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003029 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003030
3031
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003032capture cookie <name> len <length>
3033 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3035 no | yes | yes | no
3036 Arguments :
3037 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3038 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3039 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3040 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003041 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003042
3043 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3044 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3045 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3046 right if it exceeds <length>.
3047
3048 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3049 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3050 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3051 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3052
3053 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3054 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3055 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3056
3057 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3058 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3059 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003060 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3061 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3062 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003063
3064 Example:
3065 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3066
3067 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003068 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003069
3070
3071capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003072 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003073 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3074 no | yes | yes | no
3075 Arguments :
3076 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003077 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003078 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3079 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3080 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3081
3082 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3083 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3084 it exceeds <length>.
3085
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003086 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003087 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3088 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003089 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3090 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3091 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3092 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003093 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003094 environments to find where the request came from.
3095
3096 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3097 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3098 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3099 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003100
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003101 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3102 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3103 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3104 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3105 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003106
3107 Example:
3108 capture request header Host len 15
3109 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003110 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003111
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003112 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003113 about logging.
3114
3115
3116capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003117 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003118 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3119 no | yes | yes | no
3120 Arguments :
3121 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003122 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003123 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3124 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3125 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3126
3127 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3128 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3129 it exceeds <length>.
3130
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003131 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003132 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3133 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3134 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003135 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3136 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3137 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3138 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003139
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003140 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3141 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3142 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3143 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3144 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003145
3146 Example:
3147 capture response header Content-length len 9
3148 capture response header Location len 15
3149
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003150 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003151 about logging.
3152
3153
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003154compression algo <algorithm> ...
3155compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003156compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003157 Enable HTTP compression.
3158 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3159 yes | yes | yes | yes
3160 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003161 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3162 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3163 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3164
3165 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003166 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3167 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3168 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003169
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003170 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003171 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003172
3173 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3174 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3175 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3176 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3177 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003178 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003179
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003180 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3181 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3182 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3183 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3184 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3185 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3186 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003187 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003188
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003189 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003190 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003191 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3192 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3193 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3194 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3195 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003196
3197 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3198 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3199 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3200 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3201 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003202 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3203 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3204 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3205 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3206 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003207 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3208 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003209
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003210 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003211 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3212 "Accept-Encoding" header
3213 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003214 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003215 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3216 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3217 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3218 "multipart"
3219 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3220 header
3221 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3222 and later
3223 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3224 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003225 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003226
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003227 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003228
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003229 Examples :
3230 compression algo gzip
3231 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003232
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003233
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003234cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003235 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3236 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003237 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003238 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3239 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3240 yes | no | yes | yes
3241 Arguments :
3242 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3243 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3244 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3245 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3246 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3247 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003248 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003249 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3250 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3251
3252 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3253 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3254 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3255 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3256 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3257 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003258 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3259 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003260 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003261 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3262 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003263
3264 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003265 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003266
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003267 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003268 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003269 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003270 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003271 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3272 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3273 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3274 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3275 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3276 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3277 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003278
3279 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3280 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3281 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3282 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3283 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3284 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3285 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3286 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3287 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003288 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003289 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3290 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3291 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003292
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003293 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3294 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3295 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003296 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3297 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3298 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3299 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003300 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3301 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3302 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003303
3304 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3305 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3306 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3307 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3308 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3309 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3310 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3311 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3312 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3313
3314 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3315 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3316 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3317 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3318 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3319 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3320 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3321 persistence cookie in the cache.
3322 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3323
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003324 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3325 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3326 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3327 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3328 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003329 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003330 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3331 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3332 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3333 they logout.
3334
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003335 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3336 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3337 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3338 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3339
3340 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3341 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3342 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3343 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3344 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3345 this attribute.
3346
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003347 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003348 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003349 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3350 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3351 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3352 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3353 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3354 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003355
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003356 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3357 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3358 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3359 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3360 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3361 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3362 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3363 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003364 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003365 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3366 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3367 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3368 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3369 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3370 the site.
3371
3372 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3373 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3374 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3375 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3376 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3377 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3378 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3379 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3380 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3381 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3382 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3383 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3384 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003385 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003386 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3387 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3388
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003389 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3390 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3391 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3392 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3393 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3394 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3395
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003396 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3397 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3398 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3399 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003400
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003401 Examples :
3402 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3403 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3404 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003405 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003406
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003407 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003408
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003409
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003410declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3411 Declares a capture slot.
3412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3413 no | yes | yes | no
3414 Arguments:
3415 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3416
3417 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3418 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3419 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3420 for use in the response.
3421
3422 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003423 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003424 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3425
3426
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003427default-server [param*]
3428 Change default options for a server in a backend
3429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3430 yes | no | yes | yes
3431 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003432 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3433 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3434 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3435 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003436
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003437 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003438 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3439
3440 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003441
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003442
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003443default_backend <backend>
3444 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3446 yes | yes | yes | no
3447 Arguments :
3448 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3449
3450 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3451 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3452 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3453 will catch all undetermined requests.
3454
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003455 Example :
3456
3457 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3458 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3459 default_backend dynamic
3460
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003461 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003462
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003463
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003464description <string>
3465 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3467 no | yes | yes | yes
3468 Arguments : string
3469
3470 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3471 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3472 it describes.
3473 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3474
3475
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003476disabled
3477 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3478 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3479 yes | yes | yes | yes
3480 Arguments : none
3481
3482 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3483 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3484 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3485 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3486 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3487 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3488 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3489
3490 See also : "enabled"
3491
3492
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003493dispatch <address>:<port>
3494 Set a default server address
3495 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3496 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003497 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003498
3499 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3500 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3501 during start-up.
3502
3503 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3504 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3505 possible with normal servers.
3506
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003507 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003508 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3509 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3510 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3511 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3512
3513 See also : "server"
3514
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003515
3516dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3517 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3518 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3519 yes | no | yes | yes
3520 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3521
3522 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003523 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003524 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3525 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003526 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003527 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003528
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003529enabled
3530 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3531 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3532 yes | yes | yes | yes
3533 Arguments : none
3534
3535 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3536 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3537
3538 See also : "disabled"
3539
3540
3541errorfile <code> <file>
3542 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3544 yes | yes | yes | yes
3545 Arguments :
3546 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003547 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3548 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003549
3550 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003551 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003552 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003553 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3554 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003555
3556 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3557 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3558 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3559
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003560 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3561
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003562 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3563 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3564 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3565 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3566
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003567 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3568 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003569 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003570 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3571 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3572 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3573
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003574 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3575 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3576 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003577 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003578 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3579
3580 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3581
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003582 Example :
3583 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003584 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003585 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3586 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3587
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003588
3589errorloc <code> <url>
3590errorloc302 <code> <url>
3591 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3592 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3593 yes | yes | yes | yes
3594 Arguments :
3595 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003596 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3597 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003598
3599 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3600 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3601 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3602 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003603 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003604
3605 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3606 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3607 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3608
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003609 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3610
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003611 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3612 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3613 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3614 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003615 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003616 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3617 request.
3618
3619 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3620
3621
3622errorloc303 <code> <url>
3623 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3624 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3625 yes | yes | yes | yes
3626 Arguments :
3627 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003628 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3629 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003630
3631 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3632 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3633 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3634 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003635 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003636
3637 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3638 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3639 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3640
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003641 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3642
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003643 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3644 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3645 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3646 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003647 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003648
3649 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3650
3651
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003652email-alert from <emailaddr>
3653 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003654 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003655 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3656 yes | yes | yes | yes
3657
3658 Arguments :
3659
3660 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3661
3662 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3663 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3664
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003665 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003666 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3667 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003668
3669
3670email-alert level <level>
3671 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3672 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3673 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3674 yes | yes | yes | yes
3675
3676 Arguments :
3677
3678 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3679 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3680 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3681
3682 By default level is alert
3683
3684 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3685 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3686 for the proxy.
3687
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003688 Alerts are sent when :
3689
3690 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3691 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3692 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3693 is notice or lower
3694 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3695 and a health check status update occurs
3696
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003697 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3698 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003699 section 3.6 about mailers.
3700
3701
3702email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3703 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3704 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3705 yes | yes | yes | yes
3706
3707 Arguments :
3708
3709 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3710
3711 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3712 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3713
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003714 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3715 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003716
3717
3718email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3719 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3720 mailers.
3721 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3722 yes | yes | yes | yes
3723
3724 Arguments :
3725
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003726 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003727
3728 By default the systems hostname is used.
3729
3730 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3731 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3732 for the proxy.
3733
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003734 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3735 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003736
3737
3738email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003739 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003740 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3741 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3742 yes | yes | yes | yes
3743
3744 Arguments :
3745
3746 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3747
3748 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3749 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3750
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003751 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003752 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3753
3754
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003755force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3756 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3757 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003758 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003759
3760 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3761 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3762 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3763 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3764 marked down for maintenance operations.
3765
3766 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3767 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3768 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3769 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3770 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3771 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3772 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3773 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3774 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3775
3776 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3777 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3778 is used.
3779
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003780 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003781 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003782
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003783
3784filter <name> [param*]
3785 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3786 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3787 no | yes | yes | yes
3788 Arguments :
3789 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3790 referenced in section 9.
3791
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003792 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003793 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003794 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3795 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003796
3797 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3798 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3799
3800 Example:
3801 listen
3802 bind *:80
3803
3804 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3805 filter compression
3806 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3807
3808 compression algo gzip
3809 compression offload
3810
3811 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3812
3813 See also : section 9.
3814
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003815
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003816fullconn <conns>
3817 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3818 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3819 yes | no | yes | yes
3820 Arguments :
3821 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3822 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3823
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003824 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003825 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003826 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003827 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3828 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3829 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3830 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3831 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003832 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003833
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003834 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3835 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003836 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3837 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3838 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003839
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003840 Example :
3841 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3842 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3843 # connections.
3844 backend dynamic
3845 fullconn 10000
3846 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3847 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3848
3849 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3850
3851
3852grace <time>
3853 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3854 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003855 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003856 Arguments :
3857 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3858 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3859 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3860
3861 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3862 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003863 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003864 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3865
3866 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3867 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3868 simplify it.
3869
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003870
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003871hash-balance-factor <factor>
3872 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3874 yes | no | no | yes
3875 Arguments :
3876 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3877 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01003878 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003879
3880 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3881 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3882 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3883 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3884 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3885 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3886 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3887
3888 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3889 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3890 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3891 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3892 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3893
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003894 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
3895 consistent hashing mechanism.
3896
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003897 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3898
3899
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003900hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003901 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3903 yes | no | yes | yes
3904 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003905 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3906 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003907
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003908 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3909 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3910 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3911 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3912 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3913 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3914 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3915 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3916 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3917 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003918
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003919 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3920 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3921 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3922 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3923 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3924 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3925 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3926 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3927 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3928 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3929 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3930 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3931 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003932 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3933 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003934
3935 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3936
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003937 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003938 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3939 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3940 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003941 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3942 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3943 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003944
3945 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3946 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003947 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3948 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3949 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3950 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3951
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003952 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3953 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3954 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3955 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3956 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3957 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3958 parameter.
3959
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003960 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3961 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3962 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3963 used on strings.
3964
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003965 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3966
3967 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3968 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3969 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3970 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3971 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3972 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3973 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3974 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3975 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3976 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3977 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3978 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003979
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003980 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3981 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3982 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003983
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003984 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003985
3986
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003987http-check disable-on-404
3988 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003990 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003991 Arguments : none
3992
3993 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3994 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3995 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3996 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3997 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3998 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3999 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4000 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004001 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4002 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4003 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4004
4005 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
4006
4007
4008http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004009 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004011 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004012 Arguments :
4013 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4014 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004015 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004016 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4017 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4018 details on the supported keywords.
4019
4020 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4021 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4022 with the usual backslash ('\').
4023
4024 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4025 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4026 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4027 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4028 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4029
4030 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004031 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004032 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4033 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4034 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4035
4036 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004037 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004038 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4039 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4040 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4041 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4042
4043 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004044 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004045 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4046 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4047 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4048 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4049 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004050 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004051 trace).
4052
4053 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004054 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004055 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4056 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4057 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4058 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4059 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004060 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004061
4062 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4063 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4064 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4065 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4066 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4067 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4068 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4069 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4070
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004071 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4072 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4073 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4074
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004075 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4076 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4077
4078 Examples :
4079 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004080 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004081
4082 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004083 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004084
4085 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004086 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004087
4088 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004089 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004090
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004091 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004092
4093
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004094http-check send-state
4095 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4096 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4097 yes | no | yes | yes
4098 Arguments : none
4099
4100 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4101 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4102 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4103 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4104 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4105
4106 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4107 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4108 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4109 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4110 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004111 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4112 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4113 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4114
4115 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4116 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4117 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4118
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004119 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4120 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4121 checked in multiple backends.
4122
4123 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4124 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4125
4126 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4127 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4128 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4129 one fails.
4130
4131 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4132 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4133 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4134
4135 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4136 server's queue.
4137
4138 Example of a header received by the application server :
4139 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4140 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4141
4142 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4143
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004144
4145http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004146 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4147
4148 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4149 no | yes | yes | yes
4150
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004151 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4152 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4153 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4154 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4155 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004156
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004157 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4158 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004159
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004160 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004161
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004162 Example:
4163 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4164 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4165 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004166
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004167 http-request allow if nagios
4168 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4169 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4170 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004171
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004172 Example:
4173 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4174 acl add path /addacl
4175 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004176
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004177 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004178
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004179 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4180 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004181
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004182 Example:
4183 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4184 acl setmap path /setmap
4185 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004186
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004187 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004188
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004189 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4190 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004191
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004192 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4193 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004194
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004195http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004196
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004197 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4198 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4199 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4200 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4201 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4202 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4203 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4204 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004205
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004206http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004207
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004208 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4209 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4210 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4211 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4212 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4213 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4214 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4215 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004216
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004217http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004218
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004219 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4220 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004221
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004222
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004223http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004224
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004225 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4226 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4227 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4228 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4229 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004230
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004231 Example:
4232 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4233 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004234
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004235http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004236
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004237 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004238
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004239http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4240 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004241
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004242 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4243 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4244 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4245 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4246 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4247 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4248 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4249 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4250 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004251
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004252 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4253 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4254 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
4255 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword. If the slot
4256 <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration to prevent
4257 unexpected behavior at run time.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004258
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004259http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004260
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004261 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4262 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4263 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4264 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4265 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4266 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004267
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004268http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004269
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004270 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004271
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004272http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004273
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004274 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4275 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4276 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4277 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4278 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4279 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004280
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004281http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004282
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004283 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4284 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4285 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4286 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4287 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004288
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004289http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4290 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4291 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4292 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4293
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004294http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4295
4296 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4297 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4298 pointed by <resolvers>.
4299 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4300 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4301 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4302 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4303 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4304 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4305 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4306 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4307 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4308 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4309 to 0.0.0.0.
4310
4311 Example:
4312 resolvers mydns
4313 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4314 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4315 timeout retry 1s
4316 hold valid 10s
4317 hold nx 3s
4318 hold other 3s
4319 hold obsolete 0s
4320 accepted_payload_size 8192
4321
4322 frontend fe
4323 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4324 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4325 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4326
4327 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4328 # which mean DNS resolution error
4329 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4330
4331 default_backend be
4332
4333 backend b_503
4334 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4335 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4336 # 503 error page to end users
4337
4338 backend be
4339 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4340 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4341 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4342 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4343 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4344
4345 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4346 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4347
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004348http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4349
4350 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4351 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4352 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4353 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004354 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4355 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004356
4357 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4358
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004359http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004360
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004361 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4362 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4363 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4364 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4365 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004366
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004367http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004368
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004369 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4370 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4371 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4372 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004373
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004374http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4375 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004376
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004377 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field
4378 <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the
4379 <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and
4380 work like in <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header". The match is
4381 only case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4382 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they may
4383 contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas in
4384 their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004385
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004386 Example:
4387 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004388
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004389 # applied to:
4390 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004391
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004392 # outputs:
4393 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004394
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004395 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004396
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004397http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4398 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4399
4400 This matches the regular expression in the URI part of the request
4401 according to <match-regex>, and replaces it with the <replace-fmt>
4402 argument. Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a
4403 number are supported. The <fmt> field is interpreted as a log-format string
4404 so it may contain special expressions just like the <fmt> argument passed
4405 to "http-request set-uri". The match is exclusively case-sensitive. Any
4406 optional scheme, authority or query string are considered in the matching
4407 part of the URI. It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more
4408 expensive to evaluate than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit
4409 from a condition to avoid performing the evaluation at all if it does not
4410 match.
4411
4412 Example:
4413 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4414 http-request replace-uri (.*) /foo\1
4415
4416 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
4417 http-request replace-uri ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
4418
4419 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
4420 http-request replace-uri /foo/(.*) /\1
4421 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
4422 http-request replace-uri /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
4423
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004424http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4425 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004426
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004427 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4428 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4429 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4430 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004431
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004432 Example:
4433 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004434
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004435 # applied to:
4436 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004437
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004438 # outputs:
4439 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004440
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004441http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4442http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004443
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004444 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4445 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4446 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004447
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004448http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004449
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004450 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4451 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4452 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004453
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004454http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004455
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004456 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4457 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4458 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4459 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4460 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004461
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004462 Arguments:
4463 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4464 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004465
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004466 Example:
4467 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4468 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004469
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004470 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4471 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004472
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004473http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004474
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004475 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4476 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4477 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004478
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004479 Arguments:
4480 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4481 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004482
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004483 Example:
4484 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4485 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004486
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004487 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4488 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4489 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004490
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004491http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004492
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004493 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4494 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4495 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4496 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4497 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004498
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004499 Example:
4500 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4501 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4502 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4503 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4504 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4505 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4506 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4507 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4508 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004509
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004510http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004511
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004512 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4513 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4514 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4515 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4516 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004517
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004518http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4519 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004520
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004521 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4522 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4523 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4524 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4525 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4526 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4527 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4528 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4529 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004530
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004531http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004532
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004533 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4534 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4535 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4536 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4537 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4538 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4539 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004540
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004541http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004542
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004543 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4544 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4545 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004546
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004547http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004548
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004549 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4550 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4551 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4552 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4553 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4554 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4555 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4556 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004557
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004558http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004559
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004560 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4561 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4562 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4563 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4564 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4565 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004566
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004567 Example :
4568 # prepend the host name before the path
4569 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004570
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004571http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004572
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004573 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4574 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4575 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4576 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4577 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004578
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004579http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004580
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004581 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4582 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4583 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4584 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4585 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4586 values have higher priority.
4587 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4588 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4589 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4590 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4591 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004592
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004593http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004594
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004595 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4596 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4597 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4598 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4599 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4600 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4601 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004602
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004603 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004604
4605 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004606 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4607 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004608
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004609http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4610 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4611 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4612 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
4613 privacy.
4614
4615 Arguments :
4616 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4617 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004618
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004619 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004620 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4621 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4622
4623 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4624 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4625
4626http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4627
4628 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4629 expression.
4630
4631 Arguments:
4632 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4633 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004634
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004635 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004636 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4637 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4638
4639 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4640 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4641 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4642
4643http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4644
4645 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4646 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4647 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4648 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4649 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4650 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4651 information from the request.
4652
4653 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4654
4655http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4656
4657 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4658 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4659 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4660 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4661 path and the query string.
4662 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4663
4664http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4665
4666 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4667 inline.
4668
4669 Arguments:
4670 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4671 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4672 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4673 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4674 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4675 (request and response)
4676 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4677 processing
4678 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4679 processing
4680 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4681 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4682 and '_'.
4683
4684 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4685 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004686
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004687 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004688 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004689
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004690http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4691 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004692
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004693 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4694 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4695 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4696 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4697 agent name must be used.
4698
4699 Arguments:
4700 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4701
4702 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4703 configuration.
4704
4705http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4706
4707 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4708 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4709 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4710 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4711 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4712 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4713 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4714 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4715 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4716 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4717 action.
4718 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4719 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4720 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4721 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4722 you fully understand how it works.
4723
4724http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4725
4726 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4727 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4728 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4729 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4730 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4731 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4732 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4733 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4734 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4735 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4736 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4737 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4738 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4739
4740http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4741http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4742http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4743
4744 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4745 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4746 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4747 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4748 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4749 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4750 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4751 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4752 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4753 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4754 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4755 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4756
4757 Arguments :
4758 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4759 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4760 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4761 select which table entry to update the counters.
4762
4763 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4764 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4765 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4766 that table until the session ends.
4767
4768 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4769 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4770 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4771 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4772 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4773 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4774 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4775 useful information.
4776
4777 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4778 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4779 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4780 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4781 checks that make use of it.
4782
4783http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4784
4785 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004786
4787 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004788 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004789
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004790http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004791
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004792 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
4793 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
4794 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004795
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004796
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004797http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004798 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4799
4800 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4801 no | yes | yes | yes
4802
4803 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4804 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4805 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4806 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4807 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4808 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4809
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004810 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4811 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004812
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004813 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004814
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004815 Example:
4816 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004817
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004818 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004819
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004820 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4821 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004822
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004823 Example:
4824 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004825
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004826 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004827
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004828 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4829 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004830
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004831 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4832 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004833
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004834http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004835
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004836 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4837 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4838 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4839 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4840 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4841 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4842 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4843 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004844
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004845http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004846
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004847 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4848 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4849 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4850 example, or to pass some internal information.
4851 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4852 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4853 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004854
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004855http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004856
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004857 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4858 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004859
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004860http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004861
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004862 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004863
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004864http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004865
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004866 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
4867 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4868 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4869 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4870 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4871 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
4872 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004873
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004874 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
4875 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4876 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
4877 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4878 keyword.
4879 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration
4880 to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004881
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004882http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004883
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004884 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4885 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4886 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4887 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4888 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4889 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004890
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004891http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004892
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004893 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004894
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004895http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004896
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004897 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4898 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4899 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4900 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4901 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4902 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004903
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004904http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004905
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004906 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
4907 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004908
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004909http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004910
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004911 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4912 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4913 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
4914 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
4915 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
4916 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004917
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004918http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4919 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004920
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004921 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field <name>
4922 according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the <replace-fmt> argument.
4923 Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and work like in <fmt> arguments
4924 in "add-header". The match is only case-sensitive. It is important to
4925 understand that this action only considers whole header lines, regardless of
4926 the number of values they may contain. This usage is suited to headers
4927 naturally containing commas in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and
4928 so on.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004929
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004930 Example:
4931 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004932
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004933 # applied to:
4934 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004935
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004936 # outputs:
4937 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004938
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004939 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004940
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004941http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4942 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004943
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004944 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4945 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the entire
4946 header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry more than
4947 one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004948
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004949 Example:
4950 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004951
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004952 # applied to:
4953 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004954
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004955 # outputs:
4956 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004957
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004958http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4959http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004960
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004961 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4962 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4963 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004964
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004965http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004966
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004967 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4968 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4969 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004970
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004971http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004972
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004973 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4974 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4975 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4976 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4977 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004978
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004979 Arguments:
4980 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004981
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004982 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4983 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004984
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004985http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004986
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004987 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4988 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4989 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004990
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004991http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4992
4993 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4994 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4995 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4996 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
4997 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
4998
4999http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5000
5001 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5002 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5003 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5004 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5005 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5006 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5007 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5008 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5009 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5010
5011http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5012
5013 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5014 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5015 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5016 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5017 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5018 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5019 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5020
5021http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5022
5023 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5024 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5025 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5026 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5027 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5028 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5029 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5030 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5031
5032http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5033 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5034
5035 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5036 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5037 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5038 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005039
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005040 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005041 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5042 http-response set-status 431
5043 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5044 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005045
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005046http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005047
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005048 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5049 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5050 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5051 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5052 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5053 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5054 based on some information from the request.
5055
5056 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5057
5058http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5059
5060 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5061 inline.
5062
5063 Arguments:
5064 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5065 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5066 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5067 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5068 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5069 (request and response)
5070 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5071 processing
5072 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5073 processing
5074 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5075 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5076 and '_'.
5077
5078 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5079 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005080
5081 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005082 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005083
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005084http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005085
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005086 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5087 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5088 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5089 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5090 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5091 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5092 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5093 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5094 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5095 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5096 action.
5097 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5098 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5099 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5100 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5101 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005102
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005103http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5104http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5105http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005106
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005107 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5108 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5109 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5110 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5111 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5112 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5113
5114http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5115
5116 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5117 about <var-name>.
5118
5119 Example:
5120 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5121
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005122
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005123http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5124 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5125
5126 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5127 yes | no | yes | yes
5128
5129 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005130 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5131 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5132 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005133
5134 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5135
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005136 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5137 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5138 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5139 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5140 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5141 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5142 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5143 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5144 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5145 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005146
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005147 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5148 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5149 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5150 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5151 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5152 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5153 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5154 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005155
5156 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5157 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5158 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5159 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5160 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5161 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5162 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5163 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005164 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005165 downsides of rare connection failures.
5166
5167 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5168 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5169 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5170 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5171 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5172 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005173 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005174 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5175 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5176 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5177 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5178 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5179
5180 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005181 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5182 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5183 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005184
5185 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005186 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005187
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005188 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5189 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005190
5191 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
5192 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
5193 may not last after all sessions are closed.
5194
5195 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5196 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5197 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5198
5199 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5200
5201
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005202http-send-name-header [<header>]
5203 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005204 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5205 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005206 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005207 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5208
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02005209 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
5210 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
5211 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
5212 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
5213 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
5214 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
5215 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
5216 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
5217 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
5218 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
5219 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
5220 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
5221 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
5222 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
5223 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
5224 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005225
5226 See also : "server"
5227
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005228id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005229 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5230 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5231 no | yes | yes | yes
5232 Arguments : none
5233
5234 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5235 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5236 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005237
5238
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005239ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5240 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5241 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005242 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005243
5244 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5245 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5246 and running).
5247
5248 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5249 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5250 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005251 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005252 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5253
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005254 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5255 "unless" condition is met.
5256
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005257 Example:
5258 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5259 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5260 ignore-persist if url_static
5261
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005262 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5263
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005264load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5265 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5266 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5267 yes | no | yes | yes
5268
5269 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5270 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5271 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005272 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005273 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5274 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5275 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5276 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5277
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005278 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005279 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005280 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005281
5282 Arguments:
5283 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5284 named "server-state-file".
5285
5286 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5287 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5288 name is used as a file name.
5289
5290 none don't load any stat for this backend
5291
5292 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005293 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5294 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5295 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005296 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005297 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005298
5299 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5300 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5301
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005302 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005303
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005304 global
5305 stats socket /tmp/socket
5306 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005307
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005308 defaults
5309 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005310
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005311 backend bk
5312 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5313 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005314
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005315
5316 Then one can run :
5317
5318 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5319
5320 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5321
5322 1
5323 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5324 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5325 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5326
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005327 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005328
5329 global
5330 stats socket /tmp/socket
5331 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5332
5333 defaults
5334 load-server-state-from-file local
5335
5336 backend bk
5337 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5338 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5339
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005340
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005341 Then one can run :
5342
5343 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5344
5345 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5346
5347 1
5348 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5349 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5350 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5351
5352 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5353 "show servers state"
5354
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005355
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005356log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005357log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
5358 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005359no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005360 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5361 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5362 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005363
5364 Prefix :
5365 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5366 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5367 prefix does not allow arguments.
5368
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005369 Arguments :
5370 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5371 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5372 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5373 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5374 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5375 parameter.
5376
5377 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5378 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5379
5380 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5381 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5382 standard syslog port).
5383
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005384 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5385 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5386 standard syslog port).
5387
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005388 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5389 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5390 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005391 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005392
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005393 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5394 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5395 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5396 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5397 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5398 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5399 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5400 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5401 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5402 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5403 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5404 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5405 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5406 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5407 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5408 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005409 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5410 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005411
5412 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5413 and "fd@2", see above.
5414
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02005415 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
5416 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
5417 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
5418 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
5419 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
5420 having the logs instantly available.
5421
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005422 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5423 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005424
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005425 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5426 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5427 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5428 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5429 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5430 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5431 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5432 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5433 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5434 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005435 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005436
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005437 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
5438 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
5439 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
5440 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
5441 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
5442
5443 <sample_size>
5444 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
5445 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
5446 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
5447 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
5448 (see also <ranges> parameter).
5449
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005450 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5451 one of the following :
5452
5453 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5454 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5455
5456 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5457 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5458
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005459 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5460 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5461 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5462 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5463 systemd logger consumes.
5464
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005465 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5466 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5467 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5468 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5469
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005470 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5471
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005472 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5473 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5474 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5475
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005476 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5477 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5478 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5479 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005480
5481 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5482 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5483 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005484 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5485 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5486 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5487 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5488 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005489
5490 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5491
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005492 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5493 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5494 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005495
5496 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5497 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5498 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5499 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5500
5501 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5502 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005503
5504 Example :
5505 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005506 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5507 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5508 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005509 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5510 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005511 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005512
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005513
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005514log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005515 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5516 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5517 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005518
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005519 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5520 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5521 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5522 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5523 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005524
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005525 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5526 "option httplog" directives.
5527
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005528log-format-sd <string>
5529 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5530 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5531 yes | yes | yes | no
5532
5533 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5534 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5535 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5536 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5537 which covers the log format string in depth.
5538
5539 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5540 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5541
5542 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5543 log format to "rfc5424".
5544
5545 Example :
5546 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5547
5548
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005549log-tag <string>
5550 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5551 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5552 yes | yes | yes | yes
5553
5554 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5555 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5556 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5557 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5558 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5559 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5560 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5561 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5562 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005563
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005564max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5565 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5566 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5567 yes | no | yes | yes
5568
5569 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5570 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5571 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5572 servers.
5573
5574 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5575 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5576 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5577 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5578 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005579 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005580 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5581 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5582 picking a different server.
5583
5584 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5585 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5586 even if they have to be queued.
5587
5588 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5589 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5590
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005591max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5592 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5593 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5594 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005595
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005596maxconn <conns>
5597 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5598 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5599 yes | yes | yes | no
5600 Arguments :
5601 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5602 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5603 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5604 closes.
5605
5606 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5607 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5608 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5609 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005610 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5611 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5612 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5613 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005614
5615 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5616 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5617 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5618
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01005619 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
5620 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005621
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005622 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5623
5624
5625mode { tcp|http|health }
5626 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5627 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5628 yes | yes | yes | yes
5629 Arguments :
5630 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5631 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5632 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5633 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5634
5635 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5636 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5637 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5638 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5639 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5640
5641 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005642 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5643 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5644 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5645 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5646 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5647 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5648 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005649
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005650 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5651 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5652 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005653
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005654 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005655 defaults http_instances
5656 mode http
5657
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005658 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005659
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005660
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005661monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005662 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5664 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005665 Arguments :
5666 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5667 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005668 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005669 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5670 backend and its backup.
5671
5672 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5673 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5674 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5675 servers in a list of backends.
5676
5677 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5678 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5679 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5680 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5681 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5682 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5683 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005684 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5685 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005686
5687 Example:
5688 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005689 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005690 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5691 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5692 monitor-uri /site_alive
5693 monitor fail if site_dead
5694
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005695 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005696
5697
5698monitor-net <source>
5699 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5700 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5701 yes | yes | yes | no
5702 Arguments :
5703 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5704 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5705 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5706 followed by a mask.
5707
5708 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5709 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005710 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005711 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5712
5713 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5714 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5715 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5716 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005717 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5718 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5719 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005720
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005721 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5722 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5723 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5724 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5725 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5726 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005727
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005728 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5729 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005730
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005731 Example :
5732 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5733 frontend www
5734 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5735
5736 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5737
5738
5739monitor-uri <uri>
5740 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5741 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5742 yes | yes | yes | no
5743 Arguments :
5744 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5745 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5746
5747 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5748 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5749 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5750 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5751 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5752 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5753 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5754 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5755
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005756 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005757 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
5758 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
5759 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
5760 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
5761 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
5762 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005763
5764 Example :
5765 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5766 frontend www
5767 mode http
5768 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5769
5770 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5771
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005772
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005773option abortonclose
5774no option abortonclose
5775 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5776 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5777 yes | no | yes | yes
5778 Arguments : none
5779
5780 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5781 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5782 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5783 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005784 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005785 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5786 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5787 encountered while delivering the response.
5788
5789 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5790 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5791 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5792 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5793 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5794 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005795 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005796 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005797 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005798 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5799 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5800 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5801
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005802 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
5803 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005804 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5805 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5806 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5807 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5808 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5809 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005810 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005811
5812 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5813 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5814
5815 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5816
5817
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005818option accept-invalid-http-request
5819no option accept-invalid-http-request
5820 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5821 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5822 yes | yes | yes | no
5823 Arguments : none
5824
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005825 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005826 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005827 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005828 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5829 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5830 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5831 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5832 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005833 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5834 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5835 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5836 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005837 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005838 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005839 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5840 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5841 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005842
5843 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5844 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5845 been confirmed.
5846
5847 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5848 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005849 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5850 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005851 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5852
5853 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5854 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5855
5856 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5857 stats socket.
5858
5859
5860option accept-invalid-http-response
5861no option accept-invalid-http-response
5862 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5863 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5864 yes | no | yes | yes
5865 Arguments : none
5866
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005867 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005868 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005869 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005870 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5871 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5872 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5873 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5874 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005875 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5876 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5877 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005878
5879 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5880 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5881 been confirmed.
5882
5883 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5884 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5885 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5886 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5887
5888 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5889 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5890
5891 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5892 stats socket.
5893
5894
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005895option allbackups
5896no option allbackups
5897 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5899 yes | no | yes | yes
5900 Arguments : none
5901
5902 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5903 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5904 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5905 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5906 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5907 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5908 order between the backup servers anymore.
5909
5910 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5911 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5912
5913 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5914 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5915
5916
5917option checkcache
5918no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005919 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005920 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5921 yes | no | yes | yes
5922 Arguments : none
5923
5924 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5925 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005926 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005927 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5928 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005929 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005930
5931 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005932 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005933 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005934 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5935 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005936 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005937 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01005938 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
5939 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005940 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01005941 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
5942 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005943 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005944 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5945 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5946 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5947 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5948 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5949 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5950 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5951 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5952 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5953
5954 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005955 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
5956 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
5957 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
5958 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005959
5960 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5961 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005962 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005963 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005964
5965 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5966 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5967
5968
5969option clitcpka
5970no option clitcpka
5971 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5972 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5973 yes | yes | yes | no
5974 Arguments : none
5975
5976 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5977 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005978 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005979 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5980
5981 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5982 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5983 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5984 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5985
5986 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5987 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5988 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5989 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5990 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5991
5992 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5993
5994 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5995 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5996 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5997
5998 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5999 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6000
6001 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6002
6003
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006004option contstats
6005 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6006 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6007 yes | yes | yes | no
6008 Arguments : none
6009
6010 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6011 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6012 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6013 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006014 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6015 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6016 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6017 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
6018 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006019
6020
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006021option dontlog-normal
6022no option dontlog-normal
6023 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6024 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6025 yes | yes | yes | no
6026 Arguments : none
6027
6028 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6029 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6030 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6031 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6032 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6033 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6034 logged.
6035
6036 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6037 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6038 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6039
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006040 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006041 logging.
6042
6043
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006044option dontlognull
6045no option dontlognull
6046 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6047 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6048 yes | yes | yes | no
6049 Arguments : none
6050
6051 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6052 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6053 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6054 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6055 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6056 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006057 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6058 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6059 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006060
6061 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006062 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006063 would not be logged.
6064
6065 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6066 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6067
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006068 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6069 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006070
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006071
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006072option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006073 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6075 yes | yes | yes | yes
6076 Arguments :
6077 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6078 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006079 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006080 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006081
6082 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6083 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6084 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6085 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6086 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6087 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6088 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006089 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6090 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6091 possible that the client has already brought one.
6092
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006093 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006094 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006095 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006096 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006097 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006098 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006099
6100 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6101 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6102 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6103 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6104 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6105 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6106 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6107
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006108 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6109 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6110 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6111 are under the control of the end-user.
6112
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006113 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006114 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6115 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006116 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6117 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6118 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006119
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006120 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006121 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6122 frontend www
6123 mode http
6124 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6125
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006126 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6127 backend www
6128 mode http
6129 option forwardfor header X-Client
6130
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006131 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006132 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006133
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006134
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02006135option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6136no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6137 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
6138 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6139 yes | yes | yes | no
6140 Arguments : none
6141
6142 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6143 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6144 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6145 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6146 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6147 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6148 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6149
6150 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
6151 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
6152 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
6153 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6154 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
6155 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6156 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6157 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
6158 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6159 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6160
6161 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
6162
6163 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6164 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6165
6166 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
6167 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6168
6169
6170option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6171no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6172 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
6173 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6174 yes | no | yes | yes
6175 Arguments : none
6176
6177 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6178 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6179 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6180 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6181 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6182 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6183 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6184
6185 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
6186 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
6187 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
6188 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6189 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
6190 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6191 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6192 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
6193 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6194 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6195
6196 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
6197
6198 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6199 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6200
6201 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
6202 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6203
6204
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006205option http-buffer-request
6206no option http-buffer-request
6207 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6208 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6209 yes | yes | yes | yes
6210 Arguments : none
6211
6212 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6213 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6214 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6215 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6216 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6217 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
6218 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
6219 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01006220 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006221 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
6222 default.
6223
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006224 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006225
6226
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006227option http-ignore-probes
6228no option http-ignore-probes
6229 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6230 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6231 yes | yes | yes | no
6232 Arguments : none
6233
6234 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6235 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6236 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6237 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6238 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6239 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6240 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6241 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6242 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006243 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6244 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006245 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6246
6247 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6248 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6249 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6250 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6251 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6252 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6253 are often the only way to detect them.
6254
6255 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6256 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6257
6258 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6259
6260
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006261option http-keep-alive
6262no option http-keep-alive
6263 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6264 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6265 yes | yes | yes | yes
6266 Arguments : none
6267
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006268 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6269 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006270 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6271 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006272 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
6273 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
6274 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006275
6276 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6277 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006278 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6279 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6280 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6281 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6282 situations where this option may be useful :
6283
6284 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006285 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006286
6287 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6288 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6289
6290 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6291 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6292 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6293 request.
6294
6295 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6296 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006297 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6298 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6299 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006300
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006301 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6302 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6303 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6304 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6305 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6306 not set.
6307
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006308 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
6309 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
6310 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006311
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006312 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006313 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006314 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006315
6316
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006317option http-no-delay
6318no option http-no-delay
6319 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6321 yes | yes | yes | yes
6322 Arguments : none
6323
6324 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6325 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6326 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6327 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6328 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6329 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6330 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6331 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6332 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6333 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6334 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6335 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6336 affected.
6337
6338 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6339 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6340 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6341 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6342 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6343 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6344 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6345 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6346 latency environments.
6347
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006348 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6349
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006350
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006351option http-pretend-keepalive
6352no option http-pretend-keepalive
6353 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6354 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006355 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006356 Arguments : none
6357
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006358 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006359 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6360 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6361 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6362 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6363 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6364 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6365 consider the response complete.
6366
6367 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6368 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6369 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6370 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006371 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006372 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6373
6374 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6375 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6376 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6377 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6378 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6379 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6380 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6381
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006382 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6383 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6384 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6385 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6386 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6387 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006388
6389 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6390 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6391
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006392 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006393 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006394
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006395
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006396option http-server-close
6397no option http-server-close
6398 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6399 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6400 yes | yes | yes | yes
6401 Arguments : none
6402
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006403 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6404 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6405 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6406 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006407 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
6408 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
6409 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
6410 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
6411 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
6412 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
6413 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
6414 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
6415 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
6416 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
6417 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006418
6419 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6420 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6421 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6422 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006423 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6424 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006425
6426 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6427 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006428 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
6429 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
6430 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006431
6432 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6433 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6434
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006435 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6436 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006437
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006438option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006439no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006440 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6441 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6442 yes | yes | yes | no
6443 Arguments : none
6444
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006445 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006446 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6447 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6448 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6449 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6450 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6451 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6452
6453 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6454 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006455 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6456 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6457 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006458
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006459 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6460 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6461 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6462 front of an existing proxy.
6463
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006464 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6465
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006466 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006467
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006468option httpchk
6469option httpchk <uri>
6470option httpchk <method> <uri>
6471option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6472 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6474 yes | no | yes | yes
6475 Arguments :
6476 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6477 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6478 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6479 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6480 ones.
6481
6482 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6483 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6484 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6485
6486 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6487 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6488 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6489 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6490 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6491
6492 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6493 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6494 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6495 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6496 the lack of any response.
6497
6498 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6499
6500 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6501 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6502 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6503
6504 Examples :
6505 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6506 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6507 backend https_relay
6508 mode tcp
6509 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6510 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6511
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006512 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6513 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6514 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006515
6516
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006517option httpclose
6518no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006519 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6521 yes | yes | yes | yes
6522 Arguments : none
6523
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006524 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6525 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6526 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6527 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006528 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006529
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006530 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6531 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05006532 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006533 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6534 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006535
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006536 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6537 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6538 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006539
6540 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6541 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006542 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
6543 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
6544 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006545
6546 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6547 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6548
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006549 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006550
6551
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006552option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006553 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6554 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006555 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006556 Arguments :
6557 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6558 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6559 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006560 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006561 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006562
6563 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6564 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6565 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6566 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6567 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6568 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6569 ports.
6570
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006571 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6572 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006573
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006574 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6575
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006576 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006577
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006578
6579option http_proxy
6580no option http_proxy
6581 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6582 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6583 yes | yes | yes | yes
6584 Arguments : none
6585
6586 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6587 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6588 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6589 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6590 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6591
6592 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6593 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006594 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6595 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006596
6597 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6598 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6599
6600 Example :
6601 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6602 backend direct_forward
6603 option httpclose
6604 option http_proxy
6605
6606 See also : "option httpclose"
6607
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006608
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006609option independent-streams
6610no option independent-streams
6611 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6613 yes | yes | yes | yes
6614 Arguments : none
6615
6616 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6617 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6618 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6619 receive data or not.
6620
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006621 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006622 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6623 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6624 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6625 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6626 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6627 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6628 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6629 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6630 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6631 socket buffers.
6632
6633 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6634 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6635 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6636 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6637 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6638
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006639 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006640
6641
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006642option ldap-check
6643 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6645 yes | no | yes | yes
6646 Arguments : none
6647
6648 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6649 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6650 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6651 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6652
6653 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6654 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6655
6656 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6657 configure it.
6658
6659 Example :
6660 option ldap-check
6661
6662 See also : "option httpchk"
6663
6664
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006665option external-check
6666 Use external processes for server health checks
6667 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6668 yes | no | yes | yes
6669
6670 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6671 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6672 command".
6673
6674 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6675
6676 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6677
6678
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006679option log-health-checks
6680no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006681 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006682 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6683 yes | no | yes | yes
6684 Arguments : none
6685
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006686 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6687 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6688 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006689
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006690 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6691 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6692 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6693 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6694 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6695
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006696 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006697 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006698
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006699 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6700 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6701 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006702
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006703
6704option log-separate-errors
6705no option log-separate-errors
6706 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6708 yes | yes | yes | no
6709 Arguments : none
6710
6711 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6712 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6713 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6714 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6715 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6716 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6717 provides very important information.
6718
6719 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6720 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6721 error logs.
6722
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006723 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006724 logging.
6725
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006726
6727option logasap
6728no option logasap
6729 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6730 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6731 yes | yes | yes | no
6732 Arguments : none
6733
6734 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6735 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6736 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6737 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6738 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6739 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6740 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006741 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006742 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6743 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6744
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006745 Examples :
6746 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6747 mode http
6748 option httplog
6749 option logasap
6750 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6751
6752 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6753 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6754 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6755 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6756
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006757 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006758 logging.
6759
6760
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006761option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006762 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6764 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006765 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006766 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6767 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006768 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006769
6770 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6771 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006772 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006773 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6774 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6775 in the MySQL table, like this :
6776
6777 USE mysql;
6778 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6779 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6780
6781 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006782 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006783 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6784 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6785 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6786 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6787 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6788 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6789 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6790
6791 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6792 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006793
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006794 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006795
6796 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6797 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6798 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6799 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006800 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6801 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006802
6803 See also: "option httpchk"
6804
6805
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006806option nolinger
6807no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006808 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006809 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6810 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006811 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006812
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006813 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006814 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6815 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6816 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6817 connections.
6818
6819 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6820 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6821 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6822 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6823 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6824 this too.
6825
6826 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6827 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6828 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6829
6830 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6831 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6832 for servers.
6833
6834 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6835 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6836
6837
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006838option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6839 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6840 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6841 yes | yes | yes | yes
6842 Arguments :
6843 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6844 matching <network>
6845 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6846 header name.
6847
6848 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6849 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6850 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6851 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6852 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6853 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6854 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6855 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6856 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6857 possible that the client has already brought one.
6858
6859 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6860 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6861 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6862 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6863 header and requires different one.
6864
6865 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6866 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6867 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6868 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6869 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6870 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6871 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6872
6873 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6874 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6875 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6876 both are defined.
6877
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006878 Examples :
6879 # Original Destination address
6880 frontend www
6881 mode http
6882 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6883
6884 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6885 backend www
6886 mode http
6887 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6888
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006889 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006890
6891
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006892option persist
6893no option persist
6894 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6895 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6896 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006897 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006898
6899 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6900 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6901 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6902 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6903 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6904 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6905 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6906 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6907 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6908 redirected to another valid server.
6909
6910 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6911 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6912
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006913 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006914
6915
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006916option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6917 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6918 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6919 yes | no | yes | yes
6920 Arguments :
6921 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6922 PostgreSQL server.
6923
6924 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6925 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6926 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6927 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6928
6929 See also: "option httpchk"
6930
6931
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006932option prefer-last-server
6933no option prefer-last-server
6934 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6935 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6936 yes | no | yes | yes
6937 Arguments : none
6938
6939 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6940 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6941 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6942 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6943 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6944 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6945 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6946 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6947 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006948 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6949 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02006950 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
6951 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
6952 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006953 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6954 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6955 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006956
6957 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6958 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6959
6960 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6961
6962
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006963option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006964option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006965no option redispatch
6966 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6967 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6968 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006969 Arguments :
6970 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6971 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6972 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006973 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006974 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006975 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006976 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6977 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6978 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6979
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006980
6981 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6982 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6983 be able to access the service anymore.
6984
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01006985 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
6986 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006987
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006988 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006989 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6990 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006991
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006992 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6993 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6994
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006995 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006996
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006997
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006998option redis-check
6999 Use redis health checks for server testing
7000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7001 yes | no | yes | yes
7002 Arguments : none
7003
7004 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
7005 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7006 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
7007 find the "+PONG" response message.
7008
7009 Example :
7010 option redis-check
7011
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007012 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007013
7014
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007015option smtpchk
7016option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7017 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7018 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7019 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007020 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007021 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007022 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007023 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7024
7025 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7026 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7027 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7028
7029 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7030 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7031 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7032 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7033 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7034 dead server.
7035
7036 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7037 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007038 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007039 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7040
7041 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7042 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7043 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7044 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007045 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007046
7047 Example :
7048 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7049
7050 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7051
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007052
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007053option socket-stats
7054no option socket-stats
7055
7056 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7057 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7058 yes | yes | yes | no
7059
7060 Arguments : none
7061
7062
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007063option splice-auto
7064no option splice-auto
7065 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7067 yes | yes | yes | yes
7068 Arguments : none
7069
7070 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7071 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007072 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007073 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007074 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007075 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7076 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7077 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7078 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7079
7080 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7081 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7082 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7083 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7084 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7085 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7086 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7087 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7088 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7089 keyword.
7090
7091 Example :
7092 option splice-auto
7093
7094 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7095 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7096
7097 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7098 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7099
7100
7101option splice-request
7102no option splice-request
7103 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7104 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7105 yes | yes | yes | yes
7106 Arguments : none
7107
7108 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007109 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007110 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7111 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7112 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7113 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7114
7115 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7116
7117 Example :
7118 option splice-request
7119
7120 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7121 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7122
7123 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7124 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7125
7126
7127option splice-response
7128no option splice-response
7129 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7130 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7131 yes | yes | yes | yes
7132 Arguments : none
7133
7134 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007135 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007136 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7137 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7138 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7139 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7140
7141 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7142
7143 Example :
7144 option splice-response
7145
7146 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7147 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7148
7149 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7150 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7151
7152
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007153option spop-check
7154 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7155 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7156 no | no | no | yes
7157 Arguments : none
7158
7159 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7160 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7161 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7162 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7163
7164 Example :
7165 option spop-check
7166
7167 See also : "option httpchk"
7168
7169
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007170option srvtcpka
7171no option srvtcpka
7172 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7173 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7174 yes | no | yes | yes
7175 Arguments : none
7176
7177 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7178 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007179 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007180 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7181
7182 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7183 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7184 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7185 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7186
7187 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7188 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7189 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7190 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7191 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7192
7193 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7194
7195 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7196 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7197 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7198
7199 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7200 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7201
7202 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7203
7204
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007205option ssl-hello-chk
7206 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7207 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7208 yes | no | yes | yes
7209 Arguments : none
7210
7211 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7212 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7213 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7214 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7215 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7216 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7217 hello message.
7218
7219 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7220 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7221 messages, which is appreciable.
7222
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007223 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7224 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7225 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007226
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007227 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7228
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007229
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007230option tcp-check
7231 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7232 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7233 yes | no | yes | yes
7234
7235 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7236 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7237
7238 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7239 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7240 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7241
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007242 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007243 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7244 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7245 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7246 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7247 only.
7248
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007249 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007250 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7251 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7252 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7253 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7254
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007255 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007256 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7257 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007258 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007259 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7260 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7261 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7262 the respective protocols.
7263 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007264 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007265
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007266 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7267 script.
7268
7269 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7270 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7271 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7272 The "comment" is of course optional.
7273
7274
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007275 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007276 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007277 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007278 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007279
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007280 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007281 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007282 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007283
7284 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7285 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007286 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007287 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007288 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007289 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007290 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007291 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007292 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7293 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007294 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007295 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7296 tcp-check expect string +OK
7297
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007298 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007299 (send many headers before analyzing)
7300 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007301 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007302 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7303 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7304 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7305 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007306 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007307
7308
7309 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7310
7311
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007312option tcp-smart-accept
7313no option tcp-smart-accept
7314 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7315 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7316 yes | yes | yes | no
7317 Arguments : none
7318
7319 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7320 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7321 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7322 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7323 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7324 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7325
7326 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7327 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7328 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7329 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7330
7331 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7332 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7333 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007334 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007335
7336 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7337 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7338 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7339
7340 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7341 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7342 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7343
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007344 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7345
7346
7347option tcp-smart-connect
7348no option tcp-smart-connect
7349 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7350 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7351 yes | no | yes | yes
7352 Arguments : none
7353
7354 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7355 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7356 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7357 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7358 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7359
7360 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7361 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7362 complex.
7363
7364 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7365 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7366 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7367
7368 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7369 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7370
7371 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7372
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007373
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007374option tcpka
7375 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7376 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7377 yes | yes | yes | yes
7378 Arguments : none
7379
7380 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7381 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007382 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007383 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7384
7385 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7386 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7387 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7388 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7389
7390 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7391 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7392 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7393 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7394 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7395
7396 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7397
7398 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7399 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7400 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7401 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7402 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7403 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7404 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7405 backends.
7406
7407 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7408
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007409
7410option tcplog
7411 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007413 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007414 Arguments : none
7415
7416 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7417 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7418 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7419 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7420 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7421 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7422 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7423 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7424
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007425 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7426
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007427 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007428
7429
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007430option transparent
7431no option transparent
7432 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7433 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007434 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007435 Arguments : none
7436
7437 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7438 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7439 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7440 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7441 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7442 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7443 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7444 appropriate server.
7445
7446 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7447 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7448
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007449 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007450 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007451
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007452
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007453external-check command <command>
7454 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7455 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7456 yes | no | yes | yes
7457
7458 Arguments :
7459 <command> is the external command to run
7460
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007461 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7462
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007463 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007464
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007465 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7466 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7467 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7468 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7469 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7470 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007471
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007472 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7473
7474 Environment variables :
7475 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7476 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7477
7478 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7479
7480 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7481
7482 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7483 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7484 for a UNIX socket).
7485
7486 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7487
7488 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7489
7490 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7491
7492 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7493
7494 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7495
7496 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7497 socket).
7498
7499 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7500 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7501
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02007502 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
7503
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007504 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7505 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7506 failed.
7507
7508 Example :
7509 external-check command /bin/true
7510
7511 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7512
7513
7514external-check path <path>
7515 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7516 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7517 yes | no | yes | yes
7518
7519 Arguments :
7520 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7521
7522 The default path is "".
7523
7524 Example :
7525 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7526
7527 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7528 "external-check command"
7529
7530
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007531persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007532persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007533 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7534 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7535 yes | no | yes | yes
7536 Arguments :
7537 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007538 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7539 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007540
7541 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7542 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007543 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007544 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7545 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7546 forwarded to this server.
7547
7548 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7549 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7550 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007551 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007552 a single "listen" section.
7553
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007554 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7555 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7556 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7557
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007558 Example :
7559 listen tse-farm
7560 bind :3389
7561 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7562 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7563 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7564 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7565 persist rdp-cookie
7566 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007567 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007568 balance rdp-cookie
7569 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7570 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7571
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007572 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7573 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007574
7575
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007576rate-limit sessions <rate>
7577 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7578 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7579 yes | yes | yes | no
7580 Arguments :
7581 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7582 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7583
7584 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7585 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7586 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7587 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7588 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7589 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7590
7591 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7592 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7593 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7594 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7595
7596 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7597 listen smtp
7598 mode tcp
7599 bind :25
7600 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007601 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007602
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007603 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7604 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7605 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007606
7607 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7608
7609
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007610redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7611redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7612redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007613 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7614 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7615 no | yes | yes | yes
7616
7617 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007618 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007619
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007620 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007621 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007622 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7623 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7624 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007625
7626 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7627 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7628 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7629 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7630 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007631 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7632 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7633 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7634 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007635
7636 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7637 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7638 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7639 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7640 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7641 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007642 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007643 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007644 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7645 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7646 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007647
7648 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007649 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7650 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7651 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007652 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007653 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7654 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7655 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7656 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007657
7658 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007659 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007660
7661 - "drop-query"
7662 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7663 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7664 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7665 with a location-type redirect.
7666
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007667 - "append-slash"
7668 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7669 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7670 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7671 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7672
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007673 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7674 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7675 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7676 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7677 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7678 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7679 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7680
7681 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7682 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7683 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7684 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7685 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7686 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7687 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007688
7689 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7690 acl clear dst_port 80
7691 acl secure dst_port 8080
7692 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007693 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007694 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007695 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7696
7697 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007698 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7699 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7700 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007701 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007702
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007703 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7704 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7705 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7706
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007707 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007708 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007709
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007710 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007711 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7712 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7713 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007714
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007715 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007716
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007717
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007718retries <value>
7719 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7720 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7721 yes | no | yes | yes
7722 Arguments :
7723 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7724 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7725 default value is 3.
7726
7727 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7728 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7729 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7730
7731 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007732 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7733 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007734
7735 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7736 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7737
7738 See also : "option redispatch"
7739
7740
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007741retry-on [list of keywords]
7742 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
7743 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7744 yes | no | yes | yes
7745 Arguments :
7746 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
7747 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
7748 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
7749 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
7750
7751 none never retry
7752
7753 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
7754 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
7755
7756 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
7757 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
7758 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
7759 request timeout on the server side, poor network
7760 condition, or a server crash or restart while
7761 processing the request.
7762
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02007763 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
7764 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
7765 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
7766 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
7767 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
7768 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
7769 overflow attack for example).
7770
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007771 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
7772 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
7773 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
7774 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
7775 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
7776 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
7777 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
7778 amplify denial of service attacks.
7779
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02007780 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
7781 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
7782 considered to be safe to retry.
7783
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007784 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
7785 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
7786 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
7787 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
7788
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02007789 all-retryable-errors
7790 retry request for any error that are considered
7791 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
7792 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
7793 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
7794
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007795 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
7796 not cumulative.
7797
7798 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
7799 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
7800 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
7801 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
7802
7803 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
7804 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
7805 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
7806 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
7807 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
7808 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
7809 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
7810 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
7811 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
7812 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
7813 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
7814 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
7815
7816 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
7817 should not use this directive.
7818
7819 The default is "conn-failure".
7820
7821 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
7822
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007823server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007824 Declare a server in a backend
7825 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7826 no | no | yes | yes
7827 Arguments :
7828 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007829 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007830 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007831
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007832 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7833 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7834 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7835 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007836 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7837 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7838 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7839 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7840 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007841 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7842 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7843 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7844 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7845 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7846 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7847 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007848 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02007849 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
7850 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
7851 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
7852 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
7853 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
7854 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007855 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7856 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01007857 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
7858 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007859
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007860 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007861 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7862 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7863 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7864 adding this value to the client's port.
7865
7866 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7867 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007868 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007869
7870 Examples :
7871 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7872 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007873 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007874 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7875 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7876 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007877
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007878 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7879 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7880 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7881 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7882 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7883
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007884 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7885 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007886
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007887server-state-file-name [<file>]
7888 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7889 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7890 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7891 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7892 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7893 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7894
7895 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7896 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7897
7898 global
7899 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7900
7901 backend bk
7902 load-server-state-from-file
7903
7904 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7905 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007906
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02007907server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
7908 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
7909 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
7910 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7911 no | no | yes | yes
7912
7913 Arguments:
7914 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
7915
7916 <num | range>
7917 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
7918 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
7919 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
7920 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
7921
7922 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
7923
7924 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
7925
7926 <params*>
7927 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
7928 keyword.
7929
7930 Examples:
7931 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
7932 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
7933 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
7934
7935 # or
7936 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
7937
7938 # would be equivalent to:
7939 server srv1 google.com:80 check
7940 server srv2 google.com:80 check
7941 server srv3 google.com:80 check
7942
7943
7944
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007945source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007946source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007947source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007948 Set the source address for outgoing connections
7949 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7950 yes | no | yes | yes
7951 Arguments :
7952 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
7953 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007954
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007955 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007956 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
7957 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
7958 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
7959 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
7960 supported prefixes are :
7961 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7962 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7963 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007964 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02007965 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7966 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007967
7968 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
7969 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007970 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
7971 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
7972 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007973
7974 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
7975 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
7976 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
7977 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
7978 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
7979 <addr>.
7980
7981 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
7982 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
7983 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
7984 port.
7985
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007986 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
7987 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
7988 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
7989 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01007990 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007991 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
7992 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
7993 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
7994 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
7995 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
7996 HTTP header.
7997
7998 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
7999 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008000 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008001 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8002 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8003 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8004 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8005 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8006 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8007 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8008
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008009 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8010 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8011 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8012 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8013 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8014 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8015
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008016 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8017 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8018 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8019 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8020
8021 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8022 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8023 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8024 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8025 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8026 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8027
8028 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8029 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8030 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8031 there are two methods :
8032
8033 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8034 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8035 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8036 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8037 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8038 of the client ranges may be used.
8039
8040 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8041 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8042 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8043 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8044 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8045 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8046 same session.
8047
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008048 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8049 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8050 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008051 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008052
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008053 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8054
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008055 Examples :
8056 backend private
8057 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8058 source 192.168.1.200
8059
8060 backend transparent_ssl1
8061 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8062 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8063
8064 backend transparent_ssl2
8065 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8066 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8067 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8068
8069 backend transparent_ssl3
8070 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8071 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8072 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8073
8074 backend transparent_smtp
8075 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8076 # with Tproxy version 4.
8077 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8078
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008079 backend transparent_http
8080 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8081 # proxy.
8082 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8083
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008084 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008085 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8086
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008087
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008088stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8089 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8090 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008091 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008092
8093 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8094 matched.
8095
8096 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8097 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8098
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008099 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8100 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008101 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008102
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008103 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8104 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8105 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8106 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008107
8108 Example :
8109 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8110 backend stats_localhost
8111 stats enable
8112 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8113
8114 Example :
8115 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8116 backend stats_auth
8117 stats enable
8118 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8119 stats admin if TRUE
8120
8121 Example :
8122 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8123 userlist stats-auth
8124 group admin users admin
8125 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8126 group readonly users haproxy
8127 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8128
8129 backend stats_auth
8130 stats enable
8131 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8132 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8133 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8134 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8135
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008136 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8137 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8138 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008139
8140
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008141stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8142 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8143 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008144 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008145 Arguments :
8146 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8147
8148 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8149
8150 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8151 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8152 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8153 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8154 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8155 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8156
8157 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8158 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8159 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008160 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008161
8162 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8163 report using "stats scope".
8164
8165 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8166 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8167 unobvious parameters.
8168
8169 Example :
8170 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8171 backend public_www
8172 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8173 stats enable
8174 stats hide-version
8175 stats scope .
8176 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008177 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008178 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8179 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8180
8181 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8182 backend private_monitoring
8183 stats enable
8184 stats uri /admin?stats
8185 stats refresh 5s
8186
8187 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8188
8189
8190stats enable
8191 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8192 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008193 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008194 Arguments : none
8195
8196 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8197 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8198 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8199 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8200 - stats auth : no authentication
8201 - stats scope : no restriction
8202
8203 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8204 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8205 unobvious parameters.
8206
8207 Example :
8208 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8209 backend public_www
8210 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8211 stats enable
8212 stats hide-version
8213 stats scope .
8214 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008215 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008216 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8217 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8218
8219 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8220 backend private_monitoring
8221 stats enable
8222 stats uri /admin?stats
8223 stats refresh 5s
8224
8225 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8226
8227
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008228stats hide-version
8229 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008230 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008231 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008232 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008233
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008234 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8235 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8236 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8237 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8238 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8239 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008240
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008241 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8242 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8243 unobvious parameters.
8244
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008245 Example :
8246 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8247 backend public_www
8248 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008249 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008250 stats hide-version
8251 stats scope .
8252 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008253 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008254 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8255 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008256
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008257 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8258 backend private_monitoring
8259 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008260 stats uri /admin?stats
8261 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008262
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008263 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008264
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008265
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008266stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8267 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8268 Access control for statistics
8269
8270 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8271 no | no | yes | yes
8272
8273 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8274 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8275 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8276 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8277 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8278 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8279
8280 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8281 instance.
8282
8283 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8284 about ACL usage.
8285
8286
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008287stats realm <realm>
8288 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8289 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008290 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008291 Arguments :
8292 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8293 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8294 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8295
8296 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8297 using a backslash ('\').
8298
8299 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8300 only related to authentication.
8301
8302 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8303 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8304 unobvious parameters.
8305
8306 Example :
8307 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8308 backend public_www
8309 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8310 stats enable
8311 stats hide-version
8312 stats scope .
8313 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008314 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008315 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8316 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8317
8318 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8319 backend private_monitoring
8320 stats enable
8321 stats uri /admin?stats
8322 stats refresh 5s
8323
8324 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8325
8326
8327stats refresh <delay>
8328 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8329 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008330 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008331 Arguments :
8332 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8333 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8334 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8335 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8336 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8337 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8338
8339 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8340 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8341 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8342 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8343
8344 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8345 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8346 unobvious parameters.
8347
8348 Example :
8349 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8350 backend public_www
8351 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8352 stats enable
8353 stats hide-version
8354 stats scope .
8355 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008356 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008357 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8358 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8359
8360 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8361 backend private_monitoring
8362 stats enable
8363 stats uri /admin?stats
8364 stats refresh 5s
8365
8366 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8367
8368
8369stats scope { <name> | "." }
8370 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8371 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008372 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008373 Arguments :
8374 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8375 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8376 section in which the statement appears.
8377
8378 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8379 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8380 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8381 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8382 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8383 exists.
8384
8385 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8386 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8387 unobvious parameters.
8388
8389 Example :
8390 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8391 backend public_www
8392 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8393 stats enable
8394 stats hide-version
8395 stats scope .
8396 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008397 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008398 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8399 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8400
8401 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8402 backend private_monitoring
8403 stats enable
8404 stats uri /admin?stats
8405 stats refresh 5s
8406
8407 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8408
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008409
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008410stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008411 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008413 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008414
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008415 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008416 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8417
8418 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8419 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8420
8421 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8422 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008423 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008424
8425 Example :
8426 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8427 backend private_monitoring
8428 stats enable
8429 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8430 stats uri /admin?stats
8431 stats refresh 5s
8432
8433 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8434 global section.
8435
8436
8437stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008438 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8440 yes | yes | yes | yes
8441 Arguments : none
8442
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008443 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008444 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8445 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8446 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8447 - IP (socket, server)
8448 - cookie (backend, server)
8449
8450 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8451 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008452 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008453
8454 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8455
8456
8457stats show-node [ <name> ]
8458 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008460 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008461 Arguments:
8462 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8463 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8464
8465 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8466 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008467 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008468
8469 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8470 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8471 unobvious parameters.
8472
8473 Example:
8474 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8475 backend private_monitoring
8476 stats enable
8477 stats show-node Europe-1
8478 stats uri /admin?stats
8479 stats refresh 5s
8480
8481 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8482 section.
8483
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008484
8485stats uri <prefix>
8486 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008488 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008489 Arguments :
8490 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8491 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8492 query string.
8493
8494 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8495 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8496 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8497 possible to reach it in the application.
8498
8499 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008500 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008501 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8502 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8503 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8504 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8505
8506 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8507 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8508 an address or a port to statistics only.
8509
8510 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8511 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8512 unobvious parameters.
8513
8514 Example :
8515 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8516 backend public_www
8517 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8518 stats enable
8519 stats hide-version
8520 stats scope .
8521 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008522 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008523 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8524 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8525
8526 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8527 backend private_monitoring
8528 stats enable
8529 stats uri /admin?stats
8530 stats refresh 5s
8531
8532 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8533
8534
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008535stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8536 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008537 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008538 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008539
8540 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008541 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008542 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008543 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008544 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8545
8546 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8547 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8548 the "stick-table" statement.
8549
8550 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8551 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8552 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8553 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8554 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8555
8556 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8557 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8558 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8559 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8560 transformation rules.
8561
8562 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8563 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8564 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8565 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8566 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8567 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8568 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8569
8570 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8571 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8572 ACL based conditions.
8573
8574 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8575 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8576 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8577 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8578
8579 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8580 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8581 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8582 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8583
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008584 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8585 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008586 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008587
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008588 Example :
8589 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8590 # last 30 minutes
8591 backend pop
8592 mode tcp
8593 balance roundrobin
8594 stick store-request src
8595 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8596 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8597 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8598
8599 backend smtp
8600 mode tcp
8601 balance roundrobin
8602 stick match src table pop
8603 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8604 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8605
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008606 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008607 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008608
8609
8610stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8611 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8613 no | no | yes | yes
8614
8615 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8616 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8617 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8618 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8619
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008620 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8621 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008622 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008623
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008624 Examples :
8625 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008626 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008627
8628 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8629 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8630 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8631
8632
8633 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8634 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8635 backend http
8636 mode http
8637 balance roundrobin
8638 stick on src table https
8639 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8640 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8641 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8642
8643 backend https
8644 mode tcp
8645 balance roundrobin
8646 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8647 stick on src
8648 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8649 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8650
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008651 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008652
8653
8654stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8655 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8657 no | no | yes | yes
8658
8659 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008660 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008661 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008662 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008663 server is selected.
8664
8665 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8666 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8667 the "stick-table" statement.
8668
8669 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8670 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8671 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8672 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8673 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8674 address.
8675
8676 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8677 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8678 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8679 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8680 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8681 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8682 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8683 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8684 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8685 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8686
8687 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8688 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8689 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8690 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8691 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8692 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8693 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8694
8695 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8696 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8697 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8698 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8699
8700 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8701 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8702 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8703 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8704 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8705 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008706 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8707 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8708 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8709 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8710 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8711 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008712
8713 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8714 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8715 the request.
8716
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008717 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8718 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008719 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008720
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008721 Example :
8722 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8723 # last 30 minutes
8724 backend pop
8725 mode tcp
8726 balance roundrobin
8727 stick store-request src
8728 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8729 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8730 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8731
8732 backend smtp
8733 mode tcp
8734 balance roundrobin
8735 stick match src table pop
8736 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8737 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8738
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008739 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008740 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008741
8742
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008743stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008744 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8745 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008746 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008747 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008748 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008749
8750 Arguments :
8751 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8752 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8753 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8754 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8755
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008756 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8757 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8758 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8759 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8760
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008761 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8762 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8763 instance.
8764
8765 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8766 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8767 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8768 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8769 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8770 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008771 to 32 characters.
8772
8773 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8774 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8775 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008776 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008777 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8778 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008779
8780 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008781 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8782 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008783 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8784 increase.
8785
8786 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008787 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8788 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8789 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008790
8791 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8792 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8793 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8794 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008795 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008796 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8797 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8798 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8799 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8800 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8801 parameter (see below).
8802
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008803 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8804 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8805 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8806 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8807 soft restart.
8808
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008809 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8810 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008811
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008812 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8813 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8814 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8815 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008816 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008817 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008818 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8819 if not expiration delay is specified.
8820
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008821 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8822 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8823 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8824 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008825 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8826 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8827 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8828 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8829 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8830 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8831 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8832 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8833 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8834 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8835 types and their arguments.
8836
8837 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8838 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8839 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8840 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8841
8842 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8843 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8844 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008845 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008846
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008847 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8848 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8849 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008850 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008851 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008852 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008853
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01008854 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8855 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8856 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8857 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
8858
8859 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
8860 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8861 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8862 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8863 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8864 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
8865
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008866 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8867 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8868 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8869 they were received.
8870
8871 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8872 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8873 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8874 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8875 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8876
8877 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8878 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8879 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8880 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8881 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8882
8883 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8884 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8885 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8886
8887 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8888 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8889 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8890 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8891 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8892
8893 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8894 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8895 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8896 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8897 the client side.
8898
8899 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8900 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8901 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8902 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8903 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8904 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8905 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8906
8907 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8908 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8909 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8910 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8911 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8912 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008913 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008914
8915 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8916 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8917 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8918 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8919 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8920 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8921
8922 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008923 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008924 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8925 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8926
8927 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8928 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8929 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8930 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8931 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8932 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8933 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8934 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8935 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8936 recommended for better fairness.
8937
8938 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008939 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008940 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8941 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8942
8943 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8944 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8945 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8946 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8947 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8948 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
8949 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
8950 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
8951 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
8952 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008953
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008954 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
8955 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008956 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
8957 reference it.
8958
8959 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
8960 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01008961 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
8962 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
8963 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008964
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008965 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
8966 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
8967 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
8968 something that can be ignored.
8969
8970 Example:
8971 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
8972 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
8973 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
8974 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
8975
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008976 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01008977 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008978
8979
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008980stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01008981 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8983 no | no | yes | yes
8984
8985 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008986 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008987 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008988 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008989 server is selected.
8990
8991 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8992 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8993 the "stick-table" statement.
8994
8995 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8996 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8997 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
8998 when the response is a SSL server hello.
8999
9000 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9001 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9002 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9003 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9004 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9005 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009006 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009007 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9008 rules.
9009
9010 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9011 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9012 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9013 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9014 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9015 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9016 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9017
9018 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9019 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9020 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9021 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9022
9023 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9024 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9025 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9026 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9027 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9028 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009029 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9030 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9031 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9032 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9033 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9034 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9035 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9036 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9037 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009038
9039 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9040
9041 Example :
9042 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9043 backend https
9044 mode tcp
9045 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009046 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009047 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009048
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009049 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9050 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9051
9052 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9053 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9054 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9055
9056 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9057 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009058
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009059 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9060 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9061 # at offset 44.
9062
9063 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9064 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9065
9066 # Learn on response if server hello.
9067 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009068
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009069 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9070 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9071
9072 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9073 extraction.
9074
9075
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009076tcp-check connect [params*]
9077 Opens a new connection
9078 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9079 no | no | yes | yes
9080
9081 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9082 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9083 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9084
9085 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9086 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9087 of the sequence.
9088
9089 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9090 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9091 do.
9092
9093 Parameters :
9094 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9095 use the TCP connection.
9096
9097 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9098 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9099 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9100
9101 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9102
9103 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9104
9105 Examples:
9106 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9107 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9108 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9109 option tcp-check
9110 tcp-check connect
9111 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9112 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9113 tcp-check send \r\n
9114 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9115 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9116 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9117 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9118 tcp-check send \r\n
9119 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9120 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9121
9122 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9123 option tcp-check
9124 tcp-check connect port 110
9125 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9126 tcp-check connect port 143
9127 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9128 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9129
9130 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9131
9132
9133tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009134 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009135 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9136 no | no | yes | yes
9137
9138 Arguments :
9139 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9140 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9141 binary.
9142 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9143 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9144 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9145
9146 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9147 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9148 with the usual backslash ('\').
9149 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009150 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009151 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9152 used upper or lower case.
9153
9154
9155 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9156
9157 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9158 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9159 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9160 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9161 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9162 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9163 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9164 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9165
9166 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9167 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9168 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9169 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9170 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9171 expression.
9172
9173 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9174 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9175 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9176 this exact hexadecimal string.
9177 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9178
9179 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9180 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9181 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9182 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9183 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9184 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9185 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9186 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9187 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9188 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9189 the null character.
9190
9191 Examples :
9192 # perform a POP check
9193 option tcp-check
9194 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9195
9196 # perform an IMAP check
9197 option tcp-check
9198 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9199
9200 # look for the redis master server
9201 option tcp-check
9202 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009203 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009204 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9205 tcp-check expect string role:master
9206 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9207 tcp-check expect string +OK
9208
9209
9210 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9211 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9212
9213
9214tcp-check send <data>
9215 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9216 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9217 no | no | yes | yes
9218
9219 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9220 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9221
9222 Examples :
9223 # look for the redis master server
9224 option tcp-check
9225 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9226 tcp-check expect string role:master
9227
9228 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9229 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9230
9231
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009232tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9233 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009234 tcp health check
9235 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9236 no | no | yes | yes
9237
9238 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9239 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009240 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009241 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9242 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9243 hexadecimal string.
9244 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9245
9246 Examples :
9247 # redis check in binary
9248 option tcp-check
9249 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9250 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9251
9252
9253 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9254 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9255
9256
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009257tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9258 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009259 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9260 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009261 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009262 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9263 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009264
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009265 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009266
9267 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9268 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009269 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9270 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9271 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9272 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9273 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9274 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009275
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009276 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9277 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9278 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9279 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009280
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009281 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009282 - accept :
9283 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9284 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9285 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009286
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009287 - reject :
9288 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9289 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9290 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9291 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9292 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9293 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9294 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9295 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9296 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9297 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9298 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009299 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009300
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009301 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9302 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9303 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9304 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9305 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9306 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9307 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9308 hosts.
9309
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009310 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9311 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9312 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9313 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9314 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9315 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9316 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9317 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9318
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009319 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9320 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9321 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9322 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9323 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9324 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9325 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9326 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9327 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009328 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9329 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009330
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009331 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009332 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009333 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9334 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9335 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05009336 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009337 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9338 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9339 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9340 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9341 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9342 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9343 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9344 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009345
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009346 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009347 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009348 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009349 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009350 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9351 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9352 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009353
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009354 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9355 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9356 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9357 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009358
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009359 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9360 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9361 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9362 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9363 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009364 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9365 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9366 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9367 layer7 information is extracted.
9368
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009369 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9370 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9371 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9372 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9373 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009374
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009375 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9376 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9377 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9378 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9379
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009380 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9381 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9382 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9383 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9384
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009385 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9386 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9387 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9388 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9389 continues.
9390
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009391 - set-src <expr> :
9392 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9393 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9394 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009395 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009396
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009397 Arguments:
9398 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9399 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009400
9401 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009402 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9403
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009404 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9405 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009406
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009407 - set-src-port <expr> :
9408 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9409 expression.
9410
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009411 Arguments:
9412 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9413 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009414
9415 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009416 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9417
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009418 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9419 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9420 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009421
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009422 - set-dst <expr> :
9423 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9424 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9425 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9426 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9427 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9428
9429 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9430 followed by some converters.
9431
9432 Example:
9433
9434 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9435 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9436
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009437 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9438 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9439
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009440 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9441 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9442 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9443 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9444
9445
9446 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9447 followed by some converters.
9448
9449 Example:
9450
9451 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9452
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009453 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9454 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9455 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9456
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009457 - "silent-drop" :
9458 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009459 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009460 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9461 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9462 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9463 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9464 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009465 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9466 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009467 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9468 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009469 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009470 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9471 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9472 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9473 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9474
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009475 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9476 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9477 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009478
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009479 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9480 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9481 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009482
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009483 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009484 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009485 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009486
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009487 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9488 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9489 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009490
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009491 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009492 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9493 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009494
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009495 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9496
9497 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9498
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009499 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9500
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009501 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009502
9503
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009504tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9505 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009506 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009507 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009508 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009509 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9510 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009511
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009512 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009513
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009514 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009515 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9516 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9517 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9518 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009519
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009520 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9521 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9522 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9523 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009524 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9525 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9526 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9527 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9528 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9529 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009530 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009531 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009532
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009533 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9534 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9535 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9536 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009537
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009538 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009539 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01009540 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009541 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9542 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009543 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009544 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009545 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009546 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009547 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +02009548 - set-dst <expr>
9549 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009550 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009551 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009552 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009553 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009554
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009555 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9556 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01009557 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
9558 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009559
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009560 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9561 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9562 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9563 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9564 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9565 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009566
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009567 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009568 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9569 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009570
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009571 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009572 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9573 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9574 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9575 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009576 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9577 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9578 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009579
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009580 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009581 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9582 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9583 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009584
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +02009585 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
9586 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
9587
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009588 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009589 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9590 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009591
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009592 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9593 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009594 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009595 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9596 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009597 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009598 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009599 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009600 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9601 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009602 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009603 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9604 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009605
9606 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9607 followed by some converters.
9608
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009609 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9610 <var-name>.
9611
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009612 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
9613 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
9614 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
9615 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
9616 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
9617
9618 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
9619 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
9620 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
9621 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
9622 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
9623 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
9624 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
9625 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
9626 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
9627 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
9628 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
9629
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009630 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9631 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9632 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9633 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9634 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9635
9636 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9637
9638 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9639
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009640 Example:
9641
9642 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009643 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009644
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009645 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009646 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9647 # and reject everything else.
9648 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9649 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009650 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009651 tcp-request content reject
9652
9653 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009654 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9655 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9656 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009657 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009658
9659 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9660 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9661 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009662 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009663 tcp-request content reject
9664
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009665 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009666 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009667 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009668 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009669 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9670 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009671
9672 Example:
9673 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9674 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009675 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009676
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009677 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009678 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009679
9680 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009681 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009682 # protecting all our sites
9683 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009684 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9685 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009686 ...
9687 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9688
9689 backend http_dynamic
9690 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009691 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009692 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009693 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009694 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009695 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009696 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009697
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009698 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009699
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009700 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9701 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009702
9703
9704tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9705 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9706 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009707 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009708 Arguments :
9709 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9710 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9711 as explained at the top of this document.
9712
9713 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9714 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9715 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9716 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9717 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9718
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009719 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9720 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9721 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9722 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9723
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009724 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9725 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009726 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009727 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009728 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9729 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9730 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9731 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009732
9733 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9734 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9735 it pass through unaffected.
9736
9737 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9738 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9739 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009740 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009741 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9742 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009743 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9744 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9745 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009746
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009747 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009748 "timeout client".
9749
9750
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009751tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9752 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9753 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9754 no | no | yes | yes
9755 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009756 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9757 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009758
9759 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9760
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009761 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009762 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9763 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009764 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9765 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009766
9767 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9768
9769 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9770 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9771 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9772 inserted.
9773
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009774 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009775 - accept :
9776 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9777 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9778 the rules evaluation.
9779
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009780 - close :
9781 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9782 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9783 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9784 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9785 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9786 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009787 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009788 protocols.
9789
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009790 - reject :
9791 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9792 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009793 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009794
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009795 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9796 Sets a variable.
9797
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009798 - unset-var(<var-name>)
9799 Unsets a variable.
9800
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009801 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9802 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9803 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9804 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9805
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009806 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9807 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9808 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9809 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9810
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009811 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
9812 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9813 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9814 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9815 continues.
9816
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009817 - "silent-drop" :
9818 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009819 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009820 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9821 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9822 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9823 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9824 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009825 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9826 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009827 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9828 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009829 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009830 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9831 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9832 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9833 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9834
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009835 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
9836 Send a group of SPOE messages.
9837
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009838 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9839 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9840 for changing the default action to a reject.
9841
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009842 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9843 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9844 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9845 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009846 period.
9847
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009848 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9849 declared inline.
9850
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009851 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9852 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009853 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009854 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9855 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009856 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009857 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009858 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009859 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9860 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009861 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009862 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9863 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009864
9865 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9866 followed by some converters.
9867
9868 Example:
9869
9870 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9871
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009872 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9873 <var-name>.
9874
9875 Example:
9876
9877 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
9878
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009879 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9880 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9881 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9882 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9883 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9884
9885 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9886
9887 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9888
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009889 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9890
9891 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
9892
9893
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009894tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9895 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
9896 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9897 no | yes | yes | no
9898 Arguments :
9899 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9900 below.
9901
9902 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9903
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009904 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009905 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
9906 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
9907 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
9908 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
9909 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
9910 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
9911 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009912 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009913 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
9914 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
9915 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
9916 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
9917 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
9918 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
9919 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
9920 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
9921 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
9922 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
9923 instead.
9924
9925 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9926 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9927 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
9928 rules which may be inserted.
9929
9930 Several types of actions are supported :
9931 - accept : the request is accepted
9932 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9933 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
9934 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009935 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009936 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
9937 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009938 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009939 - silent-drop
9940
9941 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
9942 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
9943 sections for a complete description.
9944
9945 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9946 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9947 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
9948
9949 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
9950 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
9951 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
9952 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
9953 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
9954
9955 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9956 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9957
9958 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9959 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
9960 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
9961
9962 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9963 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
9964 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9965
9966 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
9967 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9968 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
9969
9970 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9971 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9972 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
9973
9974 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9975
9976 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
9977
9978
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009979tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
9980 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
9981 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9982 no | no | yes | yes
9983 Arguments :
9984 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9985 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9986 as explained at the top of this document.
9987
9988 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
9989
9990
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009991timeout check <timeout>
9992 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
9993 established.
9994
9995 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9996 yes | no | yes | yes
9997 Arguments:
9998 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9999 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10000 as explained at the top of this document.
10001
10002 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10003 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010004 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010005 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010006 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10007 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10008 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010009
10010 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10011 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10012
10013 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10014 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010015 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010016
10017 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10018 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10019 forget about it.
10020
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010021 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10022 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010023
10024
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010025timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010026 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10027 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10028 yes | yes | yes | no
10029 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010030 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010031 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10032 as explained at the top of this document.
10033
10034 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10035 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10036 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010037 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10038 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10039 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10040 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010041 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10042 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10043 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010044 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010045 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010046 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10047 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010048 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10049 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010050
10051 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10052 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10053 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10054 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010055 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010056 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10057
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010058 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010059
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010060 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010061
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010062
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010063timeout client-fin <timeout>
10064 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10065 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10066 yes | yes | yes | no
10067 Arguments :
10068 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10069 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10070 as explained at the top of this document.
10071
10072 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10073 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10074 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10075 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10076 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10077 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10078 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010079 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10080 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10081 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010082
10083 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10084 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10085 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10086
10087 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10088
10089
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010090timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010091 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10092 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10093 yes | no | yes | yes
10094 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010095 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010096 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10097 as explained at the top of this document.
10098
10099 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010100 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010101 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010102 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010103 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10104 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010105
10106 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10107 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10108 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10109 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010110 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010111 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10112
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010113 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010114
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010115
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010116timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10117 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10118 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10119 yes | yes | yes | yes
10120 Arguments :
10121 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10122 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10123 as explained at the top of this document.
10124
10125 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10126 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10127 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10128 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10129 once the request has started to present itself.
10130
10131 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10132 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10133 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10134 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10135 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10136
10137 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10138 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10139 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10140 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10141
10142 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10143 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010144 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010145 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10146 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010147 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010148
10149 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10150 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10151 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10152 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10153
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010154 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10155 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010156 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10157
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010158 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10159
10160
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010161timeout http-request <timeout>
10162 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10163 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010164 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010165 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010166 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010167 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10168 as explained at the top of this document.
10169
10170 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10171 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10172 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10173 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10174 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10175 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10176 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010177 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10178 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10179 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10180 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010181 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010182 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10183 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010184
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010185 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10186 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10187 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10188 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10189 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010190 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010191
10192 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10193 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010194 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010195 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10196 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10197
10198 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010199 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10200 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10201 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010202
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010203 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010204 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010205
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010206
10207timeout queue <timeout>
10208 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10210 yes | no | yes | yes
10211 Arguments :
10212 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10213 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10214 as explained at the top of this document.
10215
10216 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10217 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10218 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10219 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10220 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10221
10222 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10223 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10224 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10225 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10226
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010227 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010228
10229
10230timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010231 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10232 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10233 yes | no | yes | yes
10234 Arguments :
10235 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10236 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10237 as explained at the top of this document.
10238
10239 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10240 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10241 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10242 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10243 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10244 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10245 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10246
10247 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10248 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10249 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10250 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10251 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010252 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010253 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010254 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10255 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010256 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10257 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010258
10259 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10260 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10261 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10262 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010263 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010264 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10265
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010266 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010267
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010268
10269timeout server-fin <timeout>
10270 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10271 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10272 yes | no | yes | yes
10273 Arguments :
10274 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10275 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10276 as explained at the top of this document.
10277
10278 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10279 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10280 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10281 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10282 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10283 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10284 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10285 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10286 situations, it should not be needed.
10287
10288 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10289 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10290 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10291
10292 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10293
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010294
10295timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010296 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010297 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10298 yes | yes | yes | yes
10299 Arguments :
10300 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10301 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10302 as explained at the top of this document.
10303
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020010304 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
10305 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
10306 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010307
10308 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10309 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10310 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10311 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010312 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010313
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010314 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010315
10316
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010317timeout tunnel <timeout>
10318 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10319 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10320 yes | no | yes | yes
10321 Arguments :
10322 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10323 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10324 as explained at the top of this document.
10325
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010326 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010327 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10328 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10329 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010330 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10331 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010332 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10333 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10334 specified.
10335
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010336 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10337 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10338 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10339 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10340 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10341 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10342 state.
10343
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010344 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10345 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10346 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10347 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010348 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010349
10350 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10351 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10352 forget about it.
10353
10354 Example :
10355 defaults http
10356 option http-server-close
10357 timeout connect 5s
10358 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010359 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010360 timeout server 30s
10361 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10362
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010363 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010364
10365
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010366transparent (deprecated)
10367 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010369 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010370 Arguments : none
10371
10372 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10373 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10374 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10375 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10376 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10377 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10378 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10379 appropriate server.
10380
10381 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10382
10383 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10384 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10385
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010386 See also: "option transparent"
10387
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010388unique-id-format <string>
10389 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10390 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10391 yes | yes | yes | no
10392 Arguments :
10393 <string> is a log-format string.
10394
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010395 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10396 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10397 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10398 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010399
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010400 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10401 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10402 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10403 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10404 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10405 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10406 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10407 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010408
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010409 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10410 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010411
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010412 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010413
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010414 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010415
10416 will generate:
10417
10418 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10419
10420 See also: "unique-id-header"
10421
10422unique-id-header <name>
10423 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10424 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10425 yes | yes | yes | no
10426 Arguments :
10427 <name> is the name of the header.
10428
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010429 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10430 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010431
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010432 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010433
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010434 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010435 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10436
10437 will generate:
10438
10439 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10440
10441 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010442
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010443use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010444 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10446 no | yes | yes | no
10447 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010448 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10449 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010450
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010451 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10452 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010453
10454 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10455 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10456 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010457 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010458 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010459 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10460 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010461
10462 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10463 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10464 assign the backend.
10465
10466 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10467 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10468 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10469 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10470 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10471 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10472
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010473 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010474 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010475 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10476 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10477 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10478
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010479 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10480 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10481 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10482 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10483 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10484 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10485 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10486 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10487 cannot be forced from the request.
10488
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010489 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010490 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10491 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10492
10493 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10494 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010495
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020010496use-fcgi-app <name>
10497 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
10498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10499 no | no | yes | yes
10500 Arguments :
10501 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
10502
10503 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010504
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010505use-server <server> if <condition>
10506use-server <server> unless <condition>
10507 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10508 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10509 no | no | yes | yes
10510 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010511 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010512
10513 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10514
10515 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10516 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10517 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10518
10519 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10520 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10521 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10522 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10523 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10524 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10525 matches will assign the server.
10526
10527 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10528 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10529 with the next rules until one matches.
10530
10531 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10532 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10533 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10534 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10535
10536 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10537 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10538 stripped.
10539
10540 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10541 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10542 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10543 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10544
10545 Example :
10546 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10547 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10548 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10549 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10550 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10551 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010552 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010553 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10554 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10555
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010556 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010557
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010558
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100105595. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010560--------------------------
10561
10562The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10563depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10564settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10565written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10566described in this section.
10567
10568
105695.1. Bind options
10570-----------------
10571
10572The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10573as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10574no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10575parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10576while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10577provided immediately after the setting name.
10578
10579The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10580
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010581accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10582 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10583 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10584 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10585 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10586 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10587 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10588 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10589 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10590 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010591 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10592 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10593 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010594
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010595accept-proxy
10596 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010597 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10598 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010599 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10600 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10601 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10602 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010603 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010604 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10605 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010606 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10607 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010608
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010609allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010010610 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010010611 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010612 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010010613 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
10614 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010615
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010616alpn <protocols>
10617 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10618 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10619 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010620 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010621 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010622 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
10623 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
10624 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
10625 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
10626 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
10627 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
10628 preference, like below :
10629
10630 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010631
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010632backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010010633 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010634 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10635
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010636curves <curves>
10637 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10638 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10639 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10640 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10641 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10642 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10643
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010644ecdhe <named curve>
10645 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010646 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10647 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010648
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010649ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010650 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10651 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10652 client's certificate.
10653
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010654ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10655 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10656 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10657 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10658 error is ignored.
10659
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010660ca-sign-file <cafile>
10661 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10662 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10663 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10664 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10665 'generate-certificates' for details.
10666
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010667ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010668 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10669 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10670 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10671 'generate-certificates' for details.
10672
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010673ciphers <ciphers>
10674 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10675 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000010676 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010677 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020010678 information and recommendations see e.g.
10679 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
10680 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
10681 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
10682
10683ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
10684 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
10685 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
10686 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
10687 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010688 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
10689 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010690
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010691crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010692 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10693 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10694 to verify client's certificate.
10695
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010696crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010697 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10698 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10699 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10700 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10701 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10702 file.
10703
10704 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10705 are loaded.
10706
10707 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010708 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010709 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10710 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10711 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10712 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010713 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10714 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010715 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010716
10717 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10718 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10719 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10720 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010721 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10722 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010723
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010724 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010725
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010726 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010727 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010728 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
10729 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010730 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10731 clients).
10732
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010733 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10734 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10735 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10736 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10737 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10738 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10739 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10740 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10741 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10742 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10743 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10744 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10745 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10746
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010747 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10748 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10749 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10750 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10751 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10752
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010753 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10754 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10755 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10756 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010757
10758 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10759 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10760 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10761 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10762 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10763 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10764 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10765 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10766 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10767
10768 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10769
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010770 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010771 a cert bundle.
10772
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010773 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010774 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10775 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10776 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10777 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10778 provide multi-cert support.
10779
10780 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10781
10782 Filename | CN | SAN
10783 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10784 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010785 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010786 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10787 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10788
10789 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10790 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10791 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10792 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010793 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
10794 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
10795 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010796
10797 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10798 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10799
10800 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10801 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10802 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10803
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010804crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010805 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010806 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010807 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010808 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010809
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010810crt-list <file>
10811 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010812 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
10813 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010814
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010815 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
10816
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020010817 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
10818 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010819 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010820 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010821
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010822 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
10823 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
10824 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
10825 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
10826 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
10827 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
10828 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
10829 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010830
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010831 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020010832 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010833 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
10834 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
10835 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010836
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010837 crt-list file example:
10838 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010839 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010840 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010841 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010842
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010843defer-accept
10844 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10845 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
10846 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010847 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010848 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
10849 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
10850 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
10851 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
10852 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
10853 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
10854 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
10855
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010856expose-fd listeners
10857 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
10858 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020010859 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
10860 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010861 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010862
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010863force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010864 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010865 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010866 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010867 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010868
10869force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010870 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010871 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010872 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010873
10874force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010875 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010876 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010877 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010878
10879force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010880 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010881 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010882 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010883
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010884force-tlsv13
10885 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
10886 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010887 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010888
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010889generate-certificates
10890 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10891 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
10892 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
10893 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
10894 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
10895 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
10896 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
10897 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
10898 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
10899 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
10900 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
10901
10902 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
10903 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010904 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010905 certificate is used many times.
10906
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010907gid <gid>
10908 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
10909 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10910 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
10911 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
10912 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10913
10914group <group>
10915 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
10916 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
10917 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
10918 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
10919 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10920
10921id <id>
10922 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
10923 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
10924 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
10925 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
10926
10927interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010010928 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
10929 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
10930 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
10931 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
10932 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
10933 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010010934 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
10935 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
10936 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
10937 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
10938 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
10939 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010940
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010941level <level>
10942 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
10943 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
10944 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010945 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010946 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
10947 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
10948 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010949 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010950 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010951 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010952 all counters).
10953
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020010954severity-output <format>
10955 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
10956 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
10957 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
10958 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
10959 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
10960 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
10961 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
10962 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
10963 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
10964 rfc5424 convention.
10965
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010966maxconn <maxconn>
10967 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
10968 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
10969 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
10970 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
10971 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
10972 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
10973 eat all memory.
10974
10975mode <mode>
10976 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
10977 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
10978 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
10979 UNIX sockets.
10980
10981mss <maxseg>
10982 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
10983 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
10984 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
10985 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
10986 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
10987 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
10988 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
10989 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
10990 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
10991 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
10992 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
10993
10994name <name>
10995 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
10996 page.
10997
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010998namespace <name>
10999 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11000 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11001 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11002 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11003
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011004nice <nice>
11005 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11006 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11007 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11008 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11009 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11010 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11011 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11012 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11013 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11014 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11015 one for an RDP socket.
11016
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011017no-ca-names
11018 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11019 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11020
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011021no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011022 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011023 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011024 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011025 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011026 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11027 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011028
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011029no-tls-tickets
11030 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11031 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11032 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011033 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11034 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011035
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011036no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011037 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011038 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011039 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011040 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011041 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11042 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011043
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011044no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011045 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011046 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011047 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011048 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011049 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11050 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011051
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011052no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011053 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011054 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011055 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011056 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011057 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11058 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011059
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011060no-tlsv13
11061 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11062 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11063 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11064 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011065 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11066 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011067
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011068npn <protocols>
11069 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11070 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11071 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011072 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011073 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011074 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11075 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11076 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11077 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11078 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011079
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011080prefer-client-ciphers
11081 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11082 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11083 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011084 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11085 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11086 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011087
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011088process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011089 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011090 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011091 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011092 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11093 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11094 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11095 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011096 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011097 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11098 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11099 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11100 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11101 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011102
11103 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11104
11105 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11106 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11107 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11108 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11109 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11110 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11111 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11112 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011113
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011114proto <name>
11115 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11116 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11117 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11118 in haproxy -vv.
11119 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11120 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011121 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011122 h2" on the bind line.
11123
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011124ssl
11125 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011126 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011127 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11128 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011129 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11130 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011131
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011132ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11133 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11134 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11135 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11136
11137ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11138 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11139 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11140 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11141
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011142strict-sni
11143 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11144 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11145 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11146 See the "crt" option for more information.
11147
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011148tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011149 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011150 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11151 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011152 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011153 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11154 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11155 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11156 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11157 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11158 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11159 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11160
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011161tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011162 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011163 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11164 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11165 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11166 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11167 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11168 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11169 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011170 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11171 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11172 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011173
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011174tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11175 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011176 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11177 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11178 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11179 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11180 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11181 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11182 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11183 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11184 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11185 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011186 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11187 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11188
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011189transparent
11190 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11191 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11192 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11193 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11194 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11195 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11196 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11197 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11198 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11199 so check for support with your vendor.
11200
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011201v4v6
11202 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11203 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11204 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11205 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011206 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011207
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011208v6only
11209 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11210 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11211 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011212 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11213 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011214
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011215uid <uid>
11216 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11217 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11218 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11219 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11220 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11221
11222user <user>
11223 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11224 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11225 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11226 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11227 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11228
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011229verify [none|optional|required]
11230 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11231 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11232 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11233 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11234 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011235 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11236 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11237 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11238 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011239
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200112405.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011241------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011242
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011243The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11244which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11245arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11246settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11247after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11248Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11249address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011250
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011251 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011252 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011253
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011254Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11255keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11256
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011257The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011258
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011259addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011260 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011261 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11262 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11263 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11264 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11265 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011266
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011267agent-check
11268 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011269 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011270 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11271 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11272 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011273
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011274 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011275 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011276 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11277 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11278 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011279
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011280 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11281 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11282 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11283 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11284 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011285
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011286 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011287 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011288
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011289 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11290 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11291 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011292
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011293 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11294 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11295 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011296
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011297 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11298 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11299 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11300 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11301 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011302 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011303 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011304
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011305 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11306 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011307
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011308 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11309 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11310 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11311 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11312 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11313 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11314 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11315 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11316 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011317
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011318 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11319 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011320 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11321 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11322 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011323 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011324
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011325 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011326 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011327
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011328agent-send <string>
11329 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11330 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11331 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11332 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11333 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11334
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011335agent-inter <delay>
11336 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11337 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11338
11339 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11340 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11341 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11342 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11343 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11344 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11345 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11346 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11347 of backends use the same servers.
11348
11349 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11350
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011351agent-addr <addr>
11352 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11353
11354 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11355 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11356 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11357 hostname, it will be resolved.
11358
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011359agent-port <port>
11360 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11361
11362 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11363
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011364allow-0rtt
11365 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020011366 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
11367 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011368
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011369alpn <protocols>
11370 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11371 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11372 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011373 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011374 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
11375 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
11376 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11377 now obsolete NPN extension.
11378 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
11379 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
11380
11381 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
11382
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011383backup
11384 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11385 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11386 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11387 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011388 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11389 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011390
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011391ca-file <cafile>
11392 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11393 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11394 server's certificate.
11395
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011396check
11397 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011398 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11399 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11400 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11401 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11402 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11403 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11404 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011405 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11406 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011407 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11408 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011409
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011410check-send-proxy
11411 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11412 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11413 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11414 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11415 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11416 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11417 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11418
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010011419check-alpn <protocols>
11420 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
11421 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
11422 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11423
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011424check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011425 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011426 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
11427 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011428
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011429check-ssl
11430 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11431 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11432 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11433 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011434 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011435 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11436 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011437 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011438 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11439 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011440
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080011441check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011442 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080011443 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
11444 for normal traffic.
11445
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011446ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011447 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
11448 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
11449 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011450 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
11451 information and recommendations see e.g.
11452 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11453 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11454 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011455
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011456ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11457 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11458 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
11459 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
11460 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011461 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
11462 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
11463 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011464
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011465cookie <value>
11466 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11467 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11468 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11469 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11470 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11471 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11472 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11473
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011474crl-file <crlfile>
11475 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11476 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11477 to verify server's certificate.
11478
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011479crt <cert>
11480 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11481 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11482 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11483 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11484 certificate request.
11485
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011486disabled
11487 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11488 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11489 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11490 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11491 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011492 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011493
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011494enabled
11495 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11496 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11497 default value.
11498 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11499 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011500
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011501error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011502 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11503 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11504 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011505
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011506 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011507
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011508fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011509 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11510 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11511 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11512
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011513force-sslv3
11514 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11515 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011516 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011517 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011518
11519force-tlsv10
11520 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011521 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011522 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011523
11524force-tlsv11
11525 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011526 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011527 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011528
11529force-tlsv12
11530 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011531 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011532 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011533
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011534force-tlsv13
11535 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11536 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011537 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011538
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011539id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011540 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11541 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11542 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011543
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011544init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11545 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11546 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011547 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011548 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11549 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11550 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11551 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11552 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11553 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11554 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11555 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11556 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011557 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011558 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11559 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11560 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11561 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11562 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11563 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011564 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011565
11566 Example:
11567 defaults
11568 # never fail on address resolution
11569 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11570
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011571inter <delay>
11572fastinter <delay>
11573downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011574 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11575 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11576 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11577 between checks depending on the server state :
11578
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011579 Server state | Interval used
11580 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11581 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11582 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11583 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11584 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11585 or yet unchecked. |
11586 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11587 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11588 | "inter" otherwise.
11589 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011590
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011591 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11592 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11593 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11594 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011595 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11596 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11597 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11598 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11599 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011600
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011601maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011602 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11603 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
11604 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
11605 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
11606 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11607 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11608 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11609 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11610
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011611maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011612 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11613 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11614 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11615 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11616 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11617 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11618 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11619
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010011620max-reuse <count>
11621 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
11622 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
11623 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
11624 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
11625 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
11626 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
11627 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
11628 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
11629
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011630minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011631 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11632 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11633 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11634 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11635 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11636 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011637 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011638 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011639
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011640namespace <name>
11641 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11642 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11643 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11644 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11645
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011646no-agent-check
11647 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11648 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11649 default value.
11650 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11651 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11652
11653no-backup
11654 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11655 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11656 default value.
11657 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11658 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11659
11660no-check
11661 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11662 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11663 default value.
11664 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11665 "default-server" "check" setting.
11666
11667no-check-ssl
11668 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11669 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11670 default value.
11671 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11672 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11673
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011674no-send-proxy
11675 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11676 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11677 default value.
11678 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11679 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11680
11681no-send-proxy-v2
11682 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11683 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11684 default value.
11685 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11686 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11687
11688no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11689 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11690 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11691 default value.
11692 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11693 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11694
11695no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11696 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11697 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11698 default value.
11699 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11700 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11701
11702no-ssl
11703 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11704 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11705 default value.
11706 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11707 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11708
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011709no-ssl-reuse
11710 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11711 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11712 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11713 and for paranoid users.
11714
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011715no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011716 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11717 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011718 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011719
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011720 Supported in default-server: No
11721
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011722no-tls-tickets
11723 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11724 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11725 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011726 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11727 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011728 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011729
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011730no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011731 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011732 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11733 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011734 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11735 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011736 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011737
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011738 Supported in default-server: No
11739
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011740no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011741 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011742 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11743 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011744 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11745 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011746 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011747
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011748 Supported in default-server: No
11749
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011750no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011751 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011752 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11753 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011754 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11755 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011756 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011757
11758 Supported in default-server: No
11759
11760no-tlsv13
11761 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11762 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11763 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
11764 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11765 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011766 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011767
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011768 Supported in default-server: No
11769
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011770no-verifyhost
11771 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
11772 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11773 default value.
11774 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11775 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011776
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020011777no-tfo
11778 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
11779 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11780 default value.
11781 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11782 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
11783
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011784non-stick
11785 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
11786 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
11787 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
11788
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011789npn <protocols>
11790 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11791 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11792 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011793 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011794 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
11795 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11796 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
11797
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011798observe <mode>
11799 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
11800 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
11801 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
11802 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
11803 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
11804 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010011805 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011806
11807 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
11808
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011809on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011810 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
11811 Currently, four modes are available:
11812 - fastinter: force fastinter
11813 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
11814 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
11815 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
11816 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
11817
11818 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
11819
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011820on-marked-down <action>
11821 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
11822 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011823 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
11824 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
11825 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
11826 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
11827 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
11828 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
11829 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
11830 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011831
11832 Actions are disabled by default
11833
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011834on-marked-up <action>
11835 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
11836 Currently one action is available:
11837 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
11838 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
11839 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
11840 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011841 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
11842 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011843 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
11844 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
11845
11846 Actions are disabled by default
11847
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010011848pool-max-conn <max>
11849 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
11850 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
11851 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
11852 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
11853 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
11854 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
11855
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010011856pool-purge-delay <delay>
11857 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010011858 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020011859 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010011860
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011861port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011862 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
11863 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
11864 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
11865 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
11866 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
11867 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
11868
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020011869proto <name>
11870
11871 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
11872 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
11873 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
11874 reported in haproxy -vv.
11875 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11876 protocol for all connections established to this server.
11877
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011878redir <prefix>
11879 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
11880 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
11881 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
11882 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
11883 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
11884 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
11885 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
11886 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011887 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011888 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011889 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
11890 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
11891 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
11892 loop between the client and HAProxy!
11893
11894 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
11895
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011896rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011897 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
11898 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
11899 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
11900
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020011901resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
11902 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
11903 server.
11904
11905 Available options:
11906
11907 * allow-dup-ip
11908 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
11909 resolution at runtime is in operation.
11910 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
11911 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
11912 For such case, simply enable this option.
11913 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
11914
11915 * prevent-dup-ip
11916 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
11917 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
11918 same fqdn.
11919 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
11920
11921 Example:
11922 backend b_myapp
11923 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
11924 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
11925 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
11926
11927 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
11928 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
11929 it
11930 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
11931 different address
11932
11933 Default value: not set
11934
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011935resolve-prefer <family>
11936 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
11937 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
11938 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
11939 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
11940
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020011941 Default value: ipv6
11942
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011943 Example:
11944
11945 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011946
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011947resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011948 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011949 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011950 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011951 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
11952 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011953 configured network, another address is selected.
11954
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011955 Example:
11956
11957 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011958
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011959resolvers <id>
11960 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
11961 hostname.
11962
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011963 Example:
11964
11965 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011966
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011967 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011968
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011969send-proxy
11970 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
11971 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
11972 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
11973 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011974 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
11975 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
11976 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
11977 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
11978 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
11979 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
11980 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
11981 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
11982 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
11983 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011984 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
11985 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011986
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011987send-proxy-v2
11988 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
11989 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11990 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11991 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020011992 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
11993 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
11994 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
11995 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011996
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010011997proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
11998 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
11999 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012000 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12001 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012002 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12003 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012004 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012005
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012006send-proxy-v2-ssl
12007 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12008 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12009 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12010 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12011 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12012 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12013 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012014 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12015 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012016
12017send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12018 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12019 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12020 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12021 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12022 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12023 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12024 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12025 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012026 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12027 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012028
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012029slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012030 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12031 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12032 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12033 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12034 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12035 parameters :
12036
12037 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12038 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12039
12040 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12041 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12042 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12043 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12044
12045 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12046 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12047 seen as failed.
12048
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012049sni <expression>
12050 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12051 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12052 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12053 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012054 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12055 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012056 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012057 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12058 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012059
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012060source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012061source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012062source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012063 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12064 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12065 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12066 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12067
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012068 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12069 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12070 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12071 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12072 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12073 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12074 server.
12075
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012076 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12077 specifying the source address without port(s).
12078
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012079ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012080 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12081 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12082 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12083 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12084 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12085 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012086 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12087 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012088
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012089ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12090 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12091 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12092 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12093
12094ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12095 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12096 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12097 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12098
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012099ssl-reuse
12100 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12101 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12102 default value.
12103 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12104 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12105
12106stick
12107 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12108 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12109 default value.
12110 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12111 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012112
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012113socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012114 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012115 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
12116 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
12117
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012118tcp-ut <delay>
12119 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12120 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12121 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012122 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012123 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12124 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12125 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12126 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12127 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12128 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12129 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12130 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12131 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12132
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012133tfo
12134 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
12135 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
12136 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
12137 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
12138 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012139 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012140
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012141track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012142 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12143 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12144 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12145 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012146 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12147
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012148tls-tickets
12149 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12150 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12151 default value.
12152 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12153 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012154
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012155verify [none|required]
12156 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012157 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012158 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12159 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012160 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012161 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12162 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12163 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12164 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12165 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12166 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12167 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12168 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012169
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012170verifyhost <hostname>
12171 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012172 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12173 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12174 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12175 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12176 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12177 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12178 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12179 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012180
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012181weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012182 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12183 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12184 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012185 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12186 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12187 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12188 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12189 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12190 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012191
12192
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200121935.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12194-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012195
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012196HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12197using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12198configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012199This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12200can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12201workload.
12202This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12203resolution at run time.
12204Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12205carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12206
12207
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200122085.3.1. Global overview
12209----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012210
12211As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12212different steps of the process life:
12213
12214 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12215 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12216 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12217
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012218 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12219 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012220
12221A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12222 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12223 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12224 resolution to know this new IP.
12225
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012226When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012227HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012228SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12229from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12230will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12231will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012232
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012233A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012234 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012235 first valid response.
12236
12237 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12238 servers return an error.
12239
12240
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200122415.3.2. The resolvers section
12242----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012243
12244This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012245HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12246contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012247
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012248When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12249uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12250is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12251answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12252
12253When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012254used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012255
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012256 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12257 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12258 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012259
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012260 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12261 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012262
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012263 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12264 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12265 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012266
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012267For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12268following scenarios are possible:
12269
12270 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12271 ignored
12272
12273 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12274 applied
12275
12276 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12277 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12278
12279 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12280 retries the query with a new type
12281
12282 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12283 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012284
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012285As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12286a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012287<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012288
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012289
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012290resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012291 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012292
12293A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12294
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012295accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012296 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012297 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012298 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12299 by RFC 6891)
12300
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012301 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12302
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012303nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12304 DNS server description:
12305 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12306 <ip> : IP address of the server
12307 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12308
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012309parse-resolv-conf
12310 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12311 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12312 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12313
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012314hold <status> <period>
12315 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12316 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012317 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012318 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012319 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12320 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12321 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12322
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012323 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012324
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012325resolve_retries <nb>
12326 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12327 giving up.
12328 Default value: 3
12329
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012330 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12331 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12332 type.
12333
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012334timeout <event> <time>
12335 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12336 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12337 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012338 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12339 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012340 Default value: 1s
12341 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012342 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012343 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012344 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12345 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12346
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012347 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012348
12349 resolvers mydns
12350 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12351 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012352 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012353 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012354 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012355 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012356 hold other 30s
12357 hold refused 30s
12358 hold nx 30s
12359 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012360 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012361 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012362
12363
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123646. HTTP header manipulation
12365---------------------------
12366
12367In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
12368response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
12369request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
12370which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012371against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012372
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012373If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
12374to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
12375but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
12376HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
12377stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
12378because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
12379a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
12380still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020012381
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012382This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
12383in section 4.2 :
12384
12385 - reqadd <string>
12386 - reqallow <search>
12387 - reqiallow <search>
12388 - reqdel <search>
12389 - reqidel <search>
12390 - reqdeny <search>
12391 - reqideny <search>
12392 - reqpass <search>
12393 - reqipass <search>
12394 - reqrep <search> <replace>
12395 - reqirep <search> <replace>
12396 - reqtarpit <search>
12397 - reqitarpit <search>
12398 - rspadd <string>
12399 - rspdel <search>
12400 - rspidel <search>
12401 - rspdeny <search>
12402 - rspideny <search>
12403 - rsprep <search> <replace>
12404 - rspirep <search> <replace>
12405
12406With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
12407is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
12408parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
12409prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
12410Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
12411
12412 \t for a tab
12413 \r for a carriage return (CR)
12414 \n for a new line (LF)
12415 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
12416 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
12417 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
12418 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
12419 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
12420
12421The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
12422portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
12423above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
12424regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
124259 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
12426is very common to users of the "sed" program.
12427
12428The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
12429after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
12430
12431Notes related to these keywords :
12432---------------------------------
12433 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
12434 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
12435 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
12436
12437 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
12438 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
12439 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
12440
12441 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
12442 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
12443 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
12444 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
12445 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
12446
12447 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
12448 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
12449 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
12450 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
12451 useless headers before adding new ones.
12452
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012453 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012454 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
12455
12456 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
12457 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
12458 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
12459
12460 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
12461 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012462 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012463
12464
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200124656. Cache
12466---------
12467
12468HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
12469(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
12470RAM.
12471
12472The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
12473this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
12474
12475If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
12476independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
12477when we try to allocate a new one.
12478
12479The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
12480
12481It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
12482"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
12483for more details.
12484
12485When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
12486replaced by "<CACHE>".
12487
12488
124896.1. Limitation
12490----------------
12491
12492The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
12493
12494- If the response is not a 200
12495- If the response contains a Vary header
12496- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
12497- If the response is not cacheable
12498
12499- If the request is not a GET
12500- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
12501- If the request contains an Authorization header
12502
12503
125046.2. Setup
12505-----------
12506
12507To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
12508the corresponding http-request and response actions.
12509
12510
125116.2.1. Cache section
12512---------------------
12513
12514cache <name>
12515 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
12516 size of cache is mandatory.
12517
12518total-max-size <megabytes>
12519 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
12520 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
12521
12522max-object-size <bytes>
12523 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
12524 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
12525 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
12526
12527max-age <seconds>
12528 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
12529 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
12530 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
12531 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
12532 default.
12533
12534
125356.2.2. Proxy section
12536---------------------
12537
12538http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12539 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
12540 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
12541 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
12542 after this one.
12543
12544http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12545 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
12546 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
12547 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
12548 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
12549
12550
12551Example:
12552
12553 backend bck1
12554 mode http
12555
12556 http-request cache-use foobar
12557 http-response cache-store foobar
12558 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
12559
12560 cache foobar
12561 total-max-size 4
12562 max-age 240
12563
12564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200125657. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12566----------------------------------
12567
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012568HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012569client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12570The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12571these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12572but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12573data called patterns.
12574
12575
125767.1. ACL basics
12577---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012578
12579The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12580content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12581from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12582simple :
12583
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012584 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012585 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012586 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12587 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012589The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12590adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012591
12592In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12593
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012594 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012595
12596This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12597Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12598and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012599an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12600conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12601as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12602are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012603
12604ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12605'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12606which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12607
12608There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12609performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12610
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012611The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12612specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12613this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012614methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12615ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012616
12617Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12618 - boolean
12619 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12620 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12621 - string
12622 - data block
12623
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012624Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12625converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12626would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12627The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12628which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12629
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012630Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12631keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12632fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12633which are summarized in the table below :
12634
12635 +---------------------+-----------------+
12636 | Sample or converter | Default |
12637 | output type | matching method |
12638 +---------------------+-----------------+
12639 | boolean | bool |
12640 +---------------------+-----------------+
12641 | integer | int |
12642 +---------------------+-----------------+
12643 | ip | ip |
12644 +---------------------+-----------------+
12645 | string | str |
12646 +---------------------+-----------------+
12647 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12648 +---------------------+-----------------+
12649
12650Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12651matching method, see below.
12652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012653The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12654 - boolean
12655 - integer or integer range
12656 - IP address / network
12657 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12658 - regular expression
12659 - hex block
12660
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012661The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12662
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012663 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12664 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012665 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012666 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012667 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012668 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012669 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12670
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012671The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12672read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12673if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12674lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12675will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12676beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12677a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12678lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12679exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12680
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012681The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12682parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12683ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12684a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12685check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12686
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012687The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12688socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12689file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12690
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012691Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12692loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12693
12694 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12695
12696In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12697the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12698case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12699as well.
12700
12701The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12702sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12703do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12704methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12705is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012706obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012707followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12708default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12709that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12710string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12711
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012712The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12713By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12714string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12715resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12716server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012717waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012718flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12719function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12720
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012721There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12722sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12723be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012724
12725 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12726 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012727 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12728 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12729 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12730 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012731
12732 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12733 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012734 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012735
12736 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012737 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012738
12739 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012740 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012741
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012742 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012743 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12744
12745 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12746 binary or string samples.
12747
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012748 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12749 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012750
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012751 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12752 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12753 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012755 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12756 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012757
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012758 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12759 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012761 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12762 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012764 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12765 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012766 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12767
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012768 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12769 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12770 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012771
12772For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12773request, it is possible to do :
12774
12775 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12776
12777In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12778buffer, one would use the following acl :
12779
12780 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12781
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012782On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12783possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12784
12785 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12786
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012787All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12788criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12789method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12790to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12791criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12792the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012793
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012794If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012795the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12796For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012797
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012798 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12799 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12800 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12801 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012802
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012803
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012804The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12805types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12806combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12807brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12808default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012810 +-------------------------------------------------+
12811 | Input sample type |
12812 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012813 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012814 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12815 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12816 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012817 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012818 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012819 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012820 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012821 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012822 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012823 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012824 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012825 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012826 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012827 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012828 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012829 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012830 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012831 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012832 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012833 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012834 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012835 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012836 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012837 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012838 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12839 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12840 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012841
12842
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200128437.1.1. Matching booleans
12844------------------------
12845
12846In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12847Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12848When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12849that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12850
12851Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12852return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12853"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12854
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012855
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200128567.1.2. Matching integers
12857------------------------
12858
12859Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12860enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12861to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12862
12863Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12864matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12865lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012866
12867For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
12868unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
12869representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
12870
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012871As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
12872two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
12873instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
12874ranges and operators.
12875
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012876For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012877operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
12878Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
12879of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012880
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012881Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012882
12883 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
12884 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
12885 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
12886 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
12887 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
12888
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012889For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012890
12891 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
12892
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012893This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
12894
12895 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
12896
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200128987.1.3. Matching strings
12899-----------------------
12900
12901String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
12902different forms :
12903
12904 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012905 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012906
12907 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012908 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012909
12910 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
12911 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12912
12913 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
12914 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12915
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010012916 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012917 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
12918 matches.
12919
12920 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
12921 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
12922 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012923
12924String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
12925exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
12926characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
12927string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
12928to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012929before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012930
12931
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129327.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
12933---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012934
12935Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
12936they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
12937possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
12938passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
12939the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012940the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
12941match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012942
12943
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129447.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
12945-------------------------------------
12946
12947It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
12948not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
12949a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
12950to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
12951digits may be used upper or lower case.
12952
12953Example :
12954 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
12955 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
12956
12957
129587.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
12959---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012960
12961IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
12962netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
12963within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012964host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012965difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
12966at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
12967does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
12968parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012969
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020012970The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
12971abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
12972
12973 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12974 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
12975 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12976 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
12977 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
12978 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
12979 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
12980 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12981
12982Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
12983192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
12984
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012985IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
12986Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
12987trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
12988IPv6 patterns.
12989
12990HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
12991following situations :
12992 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
12993 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
12994 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
12995 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
12996 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
12997 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
12998 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
12999 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13000 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13001 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013003
130047.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13005----------------------------------
13006
13007Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13008combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13009
13010 - AND (implicit)
13011 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13012 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013014A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013016 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013017
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013018Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13019indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013020
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013021For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13022"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13023requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13024is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13025
13026 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013027 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13028 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13029 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013030
13031To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13032and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13033
13034 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13035 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13036 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13037 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13038
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013039 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013040 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13041 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13042 use_backend www if host_www
13043
13044It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13045expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13046be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13047the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13048
13049 The following rule :
13050
13051 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013052 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013053
13054 Can also be written that way :
13055
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013056 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013057
13058It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13059to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13060simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13061sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13062good use is the following :
13063
13064 With named ACLs :
13065
13066 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13067 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13068 monitor fail if site_dead
13069
13070 With anonymous ACLs :
13071
13072 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13073
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013074See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13075keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013076
13077
130787.3. Fetching samples
13079---------------------
13080
13081Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13082against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13083sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13084ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13085of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13086available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13087
13088This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13089Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13090compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13091deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13092
13093The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13094matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13095method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13096indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13097
13098As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13099when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13100mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13101the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13102ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13103
13104Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13105multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13106when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013107incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13108are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013109is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13110all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13111
13112Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13113 - name
13114 - name(arg1)
13115 - name(arg1,arg2)
13116
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013117
131187.3.1. Converters
13119-----------------
13120
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013121Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13122of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13123is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13124was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013125has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013126unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13127
13128These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13129sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13130the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013131support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013132
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013133A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13134support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13135supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13136(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13137bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13138
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013139The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013140
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001314151d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13142 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13143 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13144 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13145 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13146 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13147
13148 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013149 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13150 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013151 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13152 frontend http-in
13153 bind *:8081
13154 default_backend servers
13155 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13156 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13157
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013158add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013159 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013160 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013161 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13162 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013163 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013164 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13165 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13166 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13167 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013168 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013169 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013170
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013171aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13172 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13173 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13174 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13175 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13176 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13177 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13178
13179 Example:
13180 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13181 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13182
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013183and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013184 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013185 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013186 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13187 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013188 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013189 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13190 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13191 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13192 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013193 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013194 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013195
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013196b64dec
13197 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13198 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13199
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013200base64
13201 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013202 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013203 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13204
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013205bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013206 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013207 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013208 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013209 presence of a flag).
13210
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013211bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13212 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13213 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013214 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013215
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013216concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13217 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13218 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13219 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13220 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13221 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13222 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13223 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13224 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13225 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13226 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013227 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. Note that due to the config
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013228 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013229 delimiters.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013230
13231 Example:
13232 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13233 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13234 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13235 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13236
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013237cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013238 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13239 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013240
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013241crc32([<avalanche>])
13242 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13243 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13244 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13245 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13246 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13247 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13248 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13249 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13250 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13251 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013252 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13253
13254crc32c([<avalanche>])
13255 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13256 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13257 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13258 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13259 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13260 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13261 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13262 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013263
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013264da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013265 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13266 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13267 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13268 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013269 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013270 configuration language.
13271
13272 Example:
13273 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013274 bind *:8881
13275 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013276 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013277
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013278debug
13279 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
13280 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
13281 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
13282
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013283div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013284 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13285 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013286 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013287 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13288 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013289 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013290 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13291 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13292 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13293 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013294 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013295 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013296
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013297djb2([<avalanche>])
13298 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13299 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13300 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13301 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13302 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13303 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13304 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013305 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13306 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013307
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013308even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013309 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013310 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13311
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013312field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13313 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13314 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13315 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13316 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13317 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13318 fields.
13319
13320 Example :
13321 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13322 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13323 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13324 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13325 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013326
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013327hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013328 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013329 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013330 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013331 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013332
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013333hex2i
13334 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013335 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013336
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013337http_date([<offset>])
13338 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13339 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
13340 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
13341 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
13342 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
13343 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013344
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013345in_table(<table>)
13346 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13347 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13348 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013349 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013350 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13351
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013352ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13353 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013354 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013355 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13356 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13357 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13358 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13359 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013360
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013361json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013362 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013363 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013364 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013365 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13366 of errors:
13367 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13368 bytes, ...)
13369 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13370 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13371
13372 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13373 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13374 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13375 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13376 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13377 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013378 - "ascii" : never fails;
13379 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13380 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013381 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013382 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013383 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13384 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13385
13386 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013387 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013388
13389 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013390 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013391 capture request header user-agent len 150
13392 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013393
13394 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13395 GET / HTTP/1.0
13396 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13397
13398 Output log:
13399 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13400
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013401language(<value>[,<default>])
13402 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13403 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13404 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13405 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13406 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13407 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13408 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13409 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13410 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013411 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013412 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13413 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013414
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013415 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013416
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013417 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13418 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013419
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013420 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13421 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13422 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13423 use_backend spanish if es
13424 use_backend french if fr
13425 use_backend english if en
13426 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013427
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013428length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013429 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13430 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13431 type. The result is of type integer.
13432
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013433lower
13434 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13435 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13436 type. The result is of type string.
13437
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013438ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13439 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13440 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13441 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13442 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13443 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13444 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13445
13446 Example :
13447
13448 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013449 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013450 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13451
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013452map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13453map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13454map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13455 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13456 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13457 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13458 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13459 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13460 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13461 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13462 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013463
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013464 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13465 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13466 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013467
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013468 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013469 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013470
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013471 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13472 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13473 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13474 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013475 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13476 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013477 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13478 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13479 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13480 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13481 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13482 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13483 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13484 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013485 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13486 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13487 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013488 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13489 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13490 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13491 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13492 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013493
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013494 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13495 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13496 the corresponding match text.
13497
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013498 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13499 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13500 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13501 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13502 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013503
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013504 Example :
13505
13506 # this is a comment and is ignored
13507 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13508 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13509 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13510 | | | `---------- value
13511 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13512 | `---------------------------- key
13513 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13514
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013515mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013516 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13517 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013518 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013519 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013520 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013521 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13522 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13523 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13524 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013525 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013526 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013527
13528mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013529 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013530 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13531 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013532 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013533 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013534 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013535 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13536 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13537 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13538 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013539 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013540 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013541
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013542nbsrv
13543 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13544 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13545 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13546 map lookup.
13547
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013548neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013549 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13550 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13551 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13552 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013553
13554not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013555 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013556 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013557 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013558 absence of a flag).
13559
13560odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013561 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013562 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13563
13564or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013565 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013566 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013567 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13568 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013569 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013570 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13571 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13572 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13573 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013574 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013575 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013576
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013577protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
13578 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
13579 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
13580 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
13581 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
13582 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
13583 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
13584 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
13585 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
13586 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
13587 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
13588 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
13589
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010013590regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013591 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
13592 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
13593 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
13594 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
13595 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
13596 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
13597 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
13598 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
13599 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
13600 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010013601 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
13602 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
13603 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
13604 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013605
13606 Example :
13607
13608 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
13609 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
13610 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
13611 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
13612
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013613capture-req(<id>)
13614 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
13615 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13616
13617 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013618 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13619 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013620
13621capture-res(<id>)
13622 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
13623 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13624
13625 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013626 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13627 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013628
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013629sdbm([<avalanche>])
13630 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
13631 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13632 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13633 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13634 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13635 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13636 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013637 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
13638 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013639
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013640set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013641 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
13642 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
13643 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013644 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013645 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13646 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013647 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013648 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13649 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013650 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013651 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013652
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013653sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020013654 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013655 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13656
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020013657sha2([<bits>])
13658 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
13659 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
13660
13661 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
13662 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
13663
13664 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
13665 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
13666
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020013667srv_queue
13668 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
13669 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
13670 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
13671 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
13672 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
13673
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020013674strcmp(<var>)
13675 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
13676 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
13677 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
13678 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
13679 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
13680 shorter).
13681
13682 Example :
13683
13684 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
13685 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
13686 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
13687
13688
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013689sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013690 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
13691 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013692 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013693 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
13694 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013695 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013696 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13697 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013698 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013699 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13700 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013701 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013702 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013703
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013704table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13705 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13706 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13707 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13708 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13709 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13710 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13711
13712
13713table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13714 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13715 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13716 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13717 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13718 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13719 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13720
13721table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13722 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13723 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013724 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013725 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13726 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13727
13728table_conn_cur(<table>)
13729 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13730 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13731 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13732 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13733 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13734
13735table_conn_rate(<table>)
13736 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13737 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13738 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13739 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13740 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13741
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013742table_gpt0(<table>)
13743 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13744 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
13745 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13746 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13747 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
13748
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013749table_gpc0(<table>)
13750 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13751 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13752 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13753 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13754 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
13755
13756table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
13757 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13758 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13759 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
13760 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13761 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
13762 sample fetch keyword.
13763
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013764table_gpc1(<table>)
13765 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13766 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13767 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
13768 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13769 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
13770
13771table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
13772 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13773 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13774 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
13775 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13776 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
13777 sample fetch keyword.
13778
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013779table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
13780 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13781 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013782 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013783 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13784 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13785
13786table_http_err_rate(<table>)
13787 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13788 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13789 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
13790 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
13791 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
13792 keyword.
13793
13794table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
13795 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13796 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013797 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013798 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
13799 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13800
13801table_http_req_rate(<table>)
13802 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13803 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13804 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
13805 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
13806 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
13807 keyword.
13808
13809table_kbytes_in(<table>)
13810 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13811 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013812 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013813 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13814 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13815 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
13816 keyword.
13817
13818table_kbytes_out(<table>)
13819 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13820 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013821 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013822 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13823 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13824 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
13825 keyword.
13826
13827table_server_id(<table>)
13828 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13829 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13830 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
13831 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
13832 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
13833 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
13834
13835table_sess_cnt(<table>)
13836 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13837 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013838 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013839 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
13840 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13841 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
13842 keyword.
13843
13844table_sess_rate(<table>)
13845 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13846 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13847 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
13848 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
13849 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13850 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
13851 keyword.
13852
13853table_trackers(<table>)
13854 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13855 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13856 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13857 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
13858 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
13859 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
13860 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
13861 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
13862 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
13863 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
13864
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013865upper
13866 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
13867 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13868 type. The result is of type string.
13869
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020013870url_dec
13871 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
13872 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
13873
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013874ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010013875 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013876 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
13877 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
13878 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013879 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
13880 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
13881 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
13882 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013883 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013884 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
13885 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010013886
13887 Example:
13888 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
13889 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
13890
13891 message Point {
13892 int32 latitude = 1;
13893 int32 longitude = 2;
13894 }
13895
13896 message PPoint {
13897 Point point = 59;
13898 }
13899
13900 message Rectangle {
13901 // One corner of the rectangle.
13902 PPoint lo = 48;
13903 // The other corner of the rectangle.
13904 PPoint hi = 49;
13905 }
13906
13907 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
13908 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
13909 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
13910
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013911 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
13912 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013913 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013914 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
13915
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013916 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013917
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013918 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013919
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013920 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013921 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
13922 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
13923
13924 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
13925 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
13926 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
13927
13928 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
13929 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
13930 interpret the previous binary sample.
13931
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010013932
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013933unset-var(<var name>)
13934 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
13935 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
13936 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
13937 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13938 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
13939 response),
13940 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13941 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
13942 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
13943 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
13944
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013945utime(<format>[,<offset>])
13946 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13947 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
13948 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13949 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13950 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13951 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
13952
13953 Example :
13954
13955 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013956 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013957 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13958
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013959word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13960 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
13961 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
13962 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
13963 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
13964 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
13965
13966 Example :
13967 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
13968 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13969 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
13970 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
13971 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010013972
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013973wt6([<avalanche>])
13974 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
13975 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13976 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13977 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13978 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13979 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13980 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013981 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
13982 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013983
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013984xor(<value>)
13985 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013986 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013987 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013988 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013989 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013990 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13991 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013992 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013993 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13994 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013995 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013996 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013997
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010013998xxh32([<seed>])
13999 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14000 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14001 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14002 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14003 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14004 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14005 as cryptographically secure.
14006
14007xxh64([<seed>])
14008 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14009 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14010 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14011 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14012 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14013 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14014 as cryptographically secure.
14015
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014016
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200140177.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014018--------------------------------------------
14019
14020A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14021not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14022"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14023The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14024
14025always_false : boolean
14026 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14027 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14028
14029always_true : boolean
14030 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14031 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14032
14033avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014034 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014035 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14036 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14037 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14038 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14039 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14040 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14041 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14042 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14043 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14044 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14045 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14046 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14047 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014048
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014049be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014050 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14051 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14052 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14053 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014054 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14055
14056be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14057 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14058 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14059 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14060 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14061 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014062 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14063 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014064
14065 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14066 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14067 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014069be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14070 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14071 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14072 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014073 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014074 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14075 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014076
14077 Example :
14078 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14079 backend dynamic
14080 mode http
14081 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14082 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014083
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014084bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014085 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14086 of the string.
14087
14088bool(<bool>) : bool
14089 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14090 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14091
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014092connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14093 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014094 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014095 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14096 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014097
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014098 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014099 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014100 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14101
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014102 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14103 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014104
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014105 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014106 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014107 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014108 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014109 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014110 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014111 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014112
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014113 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14114 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014115 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014116 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014117
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014118cpu_calls : integer
14119 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14120 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14121 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14122 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14123 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14124 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14125
14126cpu_ns_avg : integer
14127 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14128 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14129 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14130 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14131 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14132 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14133 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14134 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14135 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14136 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14137 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14138
14139cpu_ns_tot : integer
14140 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14141 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14142 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14143 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14144 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14145 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14146 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14147 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14148 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14149 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14150 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14151 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14152 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14153
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014154date([<offset>]) : integer
14155 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
14156 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
14157 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
14158 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014159 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14160
14161 Example :
14162
14163 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14164 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014165
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014166date_us : integer
14167 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14168 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14169 from the same timeval structure.
14170
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014171distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14172 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14173 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14174 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14175 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14176 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14177 list of supported tokens.
14178
14179distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14180 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14181 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14182 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14183 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14184 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14185 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14186 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14187 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14188 supported tokens.
14189
14190 Example :
14191 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14192 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14193 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14194 # send large files to the big farm
14195 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14196
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014197env(<name>) : string
14198 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14199 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14200 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14201 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14202 certain way.
14203
14204 Examples :
14205 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14206 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14207
14208 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14209 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014211fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14212 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014213 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14214 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014215 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14216 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014217 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014218 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14219 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014220
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014221fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14222 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14223 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14224 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14225
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014226fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14227 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14228 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14229 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14230 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14231 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14232 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14233 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14234 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014235
14236 Example :
14237 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14238 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14239 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14240 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14241 frontend mail
14242 bind :25
14243 mode tcp
14244 maxconn 100
14245 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14246 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14247 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14248 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014249
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014250hostname : string
14251 Returns the system hostname.
14252
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014253int(<integer>) : signed integer
14254 Returns a signed integer.
14255
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014256ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14257 Returns an ipv4.
14258
14259ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14260 Returns an ipv6.
14261
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014262lat_ns_avg : integer
14263 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14264 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14265 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14266 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14267 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14268 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14269 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14270 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14271 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14272 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14273 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14274 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14275 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14276 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14277
14278lat_ns_tot : integer
14279 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14280 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14281 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14282 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14283 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14284 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14285 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14286 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14287 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14288 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14289 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14290 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14291 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14292 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14293 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14294 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14295 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14296 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14297 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14298
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014299meth(<method>) : method
14300 Returns a method.
14301
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014302nbproc : integer
14303 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14304 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14305 and debugging purposes.
14306
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014307nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14308 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14309 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14310 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014311 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14312 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14313 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014314
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014315prio_class : integer
14316 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14317 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14318 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14319
14320prio_offset : integer
14321 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14322 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14323 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14324 set-priority-offset".
14325
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014326proc : integer
14327 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14328 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14329 debugging purposes.
14330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014331queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014332 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14333 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14334 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014335 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14336 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14337 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14338 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14339 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14340
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014341rand([<range>]) : integer
14342 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14343 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14344 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14345 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14346 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14347
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020014348uuid([<version>]) : string
14349 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
14350 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
14351 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
14352
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014353srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14354 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14355 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14356 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14357 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14358 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014359 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14360 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14361
14362srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14363 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14364 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14365 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14366 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14367 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14368 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14369 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14370
14371 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14372 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014373
14374srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14375 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14376 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14377 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014378 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014379 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14380 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14381 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14382
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014383srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14384 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14385 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14386 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14387 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14388 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14389 fetch methods.
14390
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014391srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14392 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14393 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014394 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014395 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
14396 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014397 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014398 overloading servers).
14399
14400 Example :
14401 # Redirect to a separate back
14402 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
14403 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
14404 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
14405
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014406stopping : boolean
14407 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
14408 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
14409 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
14410
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014411str(<string>) : string
14412 Returns a string.
14413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014414table_avl([<table>]) : integer
14415 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
14416 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
14417
14418table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14419 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
14420 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
14421 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
14422
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010014423thread : integer
14424 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
14425 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
14426 and debugging purposes.
14427
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014428var(<var-name>) : undefined
14429 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014430 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
14431 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014432 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014433 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14434 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014435 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014436 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14437 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014438 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014439 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014440
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200144417.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014442----------------------------------
14443
14444The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
14445closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
14446methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
14447sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
14448TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014449the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
14450counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020014451"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
14452used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
14453can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
14454Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
14455table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
14456tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
14457currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014458
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010014459bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010014460 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14461 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14462 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
14463
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014464be_id : integer
14465 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
14466 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14467
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014468be_name : string
14469 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
14470 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14471
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014472dst : ip
14473 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
14474 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
14475 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
14476 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014477 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
14478 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
14479 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
14480 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
14481 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
14482 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014483
14484dst_conn : integer
14485 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14486 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
14487 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
14488 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
14489 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
14490 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
14491 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
14492 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014493
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014494dst_is_local : boolean
14495 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
14496 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
14497 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
14498 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014499 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014500 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
14501 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
14502 it only once per connection.
14503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014504dst_port : integer
14505 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
14506 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
14507 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
14508 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
14509 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
14510 an HTTP header.
14511
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020014512fc_http_major : integer
14513 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14514 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14515 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
14516
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020014517fc_pp_authority : string
14518 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
14519 if any.
14520
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010014521fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
14522 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
14523 header.
14524
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020014525fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
14526 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
14527 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
14528 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
14529 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14530 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14531 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14532
14533fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
14534 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
14535 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
14536 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
14537 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14538 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14539 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14540
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014541fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014542 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14543 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14544 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14545 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14546
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014547fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014548 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14549 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14550 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14551 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14552
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014553fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014554 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
14555 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14556 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14557 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14558
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014559fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014560 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
14561 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14562 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14563 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14564
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014565fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014566 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
14567 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14568 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14569 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14570
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014571fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014572 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
14573 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14574 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14575 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14576
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020014577fe_defbe : string
14578 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
14579 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
14580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014581fe_id : integer
14582 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010014583 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014584 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14585
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014586fe_name : string
14587 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
14588 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
14589 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14590
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014591sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014592sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14593sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14594sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014595 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
14596 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14597 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
14598
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014599sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014600sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14601sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14602sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014603 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
14604 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14605 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
14606
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014607sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014608sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14609sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14610sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014611 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14612 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014613 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14614 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14615 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014616
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014617 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014618 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14619 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014620 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14621 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
14622 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014623 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14624 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14625
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014626sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14627sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14628sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14629sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14630 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14631 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
14632 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14633 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14634 when a first ACL was verified.
14635
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014636sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014637sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14638sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14639sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014640 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014641 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
14642
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014643sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014644sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14645sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14646sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014647 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14648 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
14649 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
14650
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014651sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014652sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14653sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14654sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014655 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
14656 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
14657 See also src_conn_rate.
14658
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014659sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014660sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14661sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14662sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014663 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014664 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014665
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014666sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14667sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14668sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14669sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14670 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14671 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14672
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014673sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14674sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14675sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14676sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14677 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14678 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
14679
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014680sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014681sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14682sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14683sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014684 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
14685 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14686 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014687 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14688 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14689 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014690
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014691sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14692sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14693sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14694sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14695 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14696 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14697 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14698 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14699 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14700 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14701
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014702sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014703sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14704sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14705sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014706 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014707 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
14708 See also src_http_err_cnt.
14709
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014710sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014711sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14712sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14713sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014714 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
14715 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14716 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
14717 src_http_err_rate.
14718
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014719sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014720sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14721sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14722sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014723 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014724 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14725 src_http_req_cnt.
14726
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014727sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014728sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14729sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14730sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014731 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
14732 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
14733 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14734 src_http_req_rate.
14735
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014736sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014737sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14738sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14739sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014740 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014741 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14742 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14743 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14744 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014745
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014746 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014747 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14748 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014749 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14750
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014751sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14752sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14753sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14754sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14755 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
14756 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14757 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14758 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14759 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
14760
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014761sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014762sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14763sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14764sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014765 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
14766 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14767 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014768
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014769sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014770sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14771sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14772sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014773 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
14774 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14775 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014776
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014777sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014778sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14779sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14780sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014781 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014782 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
14783 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
14784 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014785 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014786 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
14787
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014788sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014789sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14790sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14791sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014792 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
14793 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14794 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
14795 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
14796 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014797 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014798
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014799sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014800sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14801sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14802sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020014803 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
14804 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
14805 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
14806
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014807sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014808sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14809sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14810sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014811 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14812 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014813 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014814 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
14815 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014816 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
14817 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
14818 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014819
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014820so_id : integer
14821 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
14822 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
14823 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014825src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014826 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014827 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
14828 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
14829 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014830 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
14831 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
14832 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014833 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
14834 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
14835 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
14836 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
14837 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
14838 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
14839 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014840
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014841 Example:
14842 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
14843 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
14844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014845src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14846 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
14847 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
14848 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014849 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014851src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14852 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
14853 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014854 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014855 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014856
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014857src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14858 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14859 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14860 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14861 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14862 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14863 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014864
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014865 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014866 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14867 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
14868 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
14869 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014870 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014871 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14872 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14873
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014874src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14875 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14876 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14877 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14878 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14879 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14880 was verified.
14881
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014882src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014883 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014884 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014885 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014886 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014887
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014888src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014889 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014890 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14891 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014892 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014893
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014894src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14895 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
14896 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14897 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014898 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014900src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014901 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014902 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014903 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014904 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014905
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014906src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14907 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14908 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14909 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14910 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
14911
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014912src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14913 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14914 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14915 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14916 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
14917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014918src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014919 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014920 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014921 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14922 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014923 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14924 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14925 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014926
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014927src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14928 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14929 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14930 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14931 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14932 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14933 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14934 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14935
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014936src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014937 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014938 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014939 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014940 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014941 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014942
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014943src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14944 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
14945 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14946 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14947 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014948 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014950src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014951 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014952 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14953 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014954 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014955
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014956src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14957 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
14958 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14959 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014960 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014961 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014962
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014963src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14964 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14965 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14966 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014967 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014968 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14969 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014970
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014971 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014972 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014973 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014974 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014975
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014976src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14977 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14978 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14979 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
14980 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14981 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14982 connection when a first ACL was verified.
14983
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014984src_is_local : boolean
14985 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
14986 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
14987 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
14988 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014989 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014990 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
14991 once per connection.
14992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014993src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014994 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
14995 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
14996 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
14997 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
14998 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014999
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015000src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015001 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15002 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15003 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15004 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15005 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015006
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015007src_port : integer
15008 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15009 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15010 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15011 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015012
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015013src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015014 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015015 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15016 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15017 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015018 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015019
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015020src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15021 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15022 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15023 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15024 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015025 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015027src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15028 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15029 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15030 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15031 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15032 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15033 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15034 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15035 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015036
15037 Example :
15038 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15039 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15040 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15041 listen ssh
15042 bind :22
15043 mode tcp
15044 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015045 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015046 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015047 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15048
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015049srv_id : integer
15050 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15051 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15052 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015053
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200150547.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015055----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015056
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015057The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15058closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15059when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15060usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015061future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015062
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001506351d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15064 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15065 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15066 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15067 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15068 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15069
15070 Example :
15071 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15072 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15073 # the request.
15074 frontend http-in
15075 bind *:8081
15076 default_backend servers
15077 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15078 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15079
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015080ssl_bc : boolean
15081 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15082 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15083 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15084
15085ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15086 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15087 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15088
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015089ssl_bc_alpn : string
15090 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15091 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015092 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015093 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15094 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15095 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15096 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15097 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15098 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15099
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015100ssl_bc_cipher : string
15101 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15102 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15103
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015104ssl_bc_client_random : binary
15105 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15106 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15107 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15108
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015109ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15110 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15111 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15112 session or a TLS ticket.
15113
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015114ssl_bc_npn : string
15115 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15116 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015117 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015118 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15119 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15120 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15121 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15122 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15123
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015124ssl_bc_protocol : string
15125 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15126 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15127
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015128ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015129 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015130 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15131 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015132
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015133ssl_bc_server_random : binary
15134 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15135 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15136 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15137
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015138ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15139 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15140 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15141 if session was reused or not.
15142
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015143ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15144 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15145 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15146 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15147 BoringSSL.
15148
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015149ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15150 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15151 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15152
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015153ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15154 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15155 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15156 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15157 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15158 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015160ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15161 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15162 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15163 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15164 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015165
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015166ssl_c_der : binary
15167 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15168 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15169 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015171ssl_c_err : integer
15172 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15173 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15174 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15175 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15176 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015178ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15179 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15180 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15181 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15182 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15183 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15184 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15185 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15186 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015187
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015188ssl_c_key_alg : string
15189 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15190 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15191 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015192
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015193ssl_c_notafter : string
15194 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15195 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15196 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015197
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015198ssl_c_notbefore : string
15199 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15200 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15201 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015202
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015203ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15204 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15205 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15206 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15207 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15208 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15209 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15210 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15211 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015213ssl_c_serial : binary
15214 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15215 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15216 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015218ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15219 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15220 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15221 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015222 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15223 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15224
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015225 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015226 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015227
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015228ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15229 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15230 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15231 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015232
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015233ssl_c_used : boolean
15234 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15235 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015237ssl_c_verify : integer
15238 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15239 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15240 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15241 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015242
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015243ssl_c_version : integer
15244 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15245 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015246
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015247ssl_f_der : binary
15248 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15249 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15250 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015252ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15253 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15254 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15255 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15256 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015257 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015258 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15259 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15260 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015261
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015262ssl_f_key_alg : string
15263 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15264 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15265 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015266
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015267ssl_f_notafter : string
15268 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15269 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15270 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015271
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015272ssl_f_notbefore : string
15273 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15274 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15275 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015277ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15278 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15279 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15280 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15281 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15282 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15283 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15284 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15285 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015286
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015287ssl_f_serial : binary
15288 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15289 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15290 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015291
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015292ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15293 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15294 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15295 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15296
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015297ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15298 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15299 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15300 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015301
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015302ssl_f_version : integer
15303 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15304 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15305
15306ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015307 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15308 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15309 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15310
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015311 Example :
15312 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15313 listen http-https
15314 bind :80
15315 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15316 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15317
15318ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15319 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15320 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15321
15322ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015323 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015324 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15325 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15326 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15327 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15328 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15329 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15330 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15331 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15332
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015333ssl_fc_cipher : string
15334 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15335 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015336
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015337ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15338 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15339 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015340 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015341
15342ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15343 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15344 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015345 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015346
15347ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15348 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15349 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15350 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015351 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015352 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015353
15354ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15355 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15356 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015357 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015358
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015359ssl_fc_client_random : binary
15360 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15361 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15362 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15363
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015364ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015365 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15366 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015367 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15368 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15369 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15370 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015371
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015372ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15373 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15374 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15375 wait until the handshake happened.
15376
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015377ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15378 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015379 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15380 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015381 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015382 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015383
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015384ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015385 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015386 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15387 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015389ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015390 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015391 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
15392 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
15393 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15394 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
15395 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
15396 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
15397 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020015398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015399ssl_fc_protocol : string
15400 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
15401 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015402
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015403ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015404 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015405 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15406 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015407
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015408ssl_fc_server_random : binary
15409 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15410 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15411 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15412
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015413ssl_fc_session_id : binary
15414 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
15415 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
15416 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
15417 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015418
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015419ssl_fc_session_key : binary
15420 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
15421 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15422 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15423 BoringSSL.
15424
15425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015426ssl_fc_sni : string
15427 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
15428 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
15429 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
15430 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
15431 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
15432
15433 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
15434 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
15435 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015436 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020015437 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015438
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015439 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015440 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
15441 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020015442
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015443ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
15444 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
15445 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015446
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015447
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200154487.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015449------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015451Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
15452sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
15453only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
15454For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
15455be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
15456can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
15457sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
15458for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
15459content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015460
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015461payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015462 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015463 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
15464 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015465
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015466payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
15467 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015468 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015469 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015470
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020015471req.hdrs : string
15472 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
15473 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
15474 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
15475 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
15476
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020015477req.hdrs_bin : binary
15478 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
15479 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
15480 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
15481 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
15482 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
15483 names and values (length of 0 for both).
15484
15485 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
15486
15487 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
15488 str: <int:length><bytes>
15489
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015490req.len : integer
15491req_len : integer (deprecated)
15492 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15493 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15494 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15495 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15496 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15497 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15498 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
15499 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015500
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015501req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15502 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015503 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15504 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15505 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15506 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015507
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015508 ACL alternatives :
15509 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015511req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15512 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15513 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15514 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
15515 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015517 ACL alternatives :
15518 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015520 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015521
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015522req.proto_http : boolean
15523req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
15524 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
15525 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
15526 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
15527 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
15528 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
15529 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
15530 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015531
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015532 Example:
15533 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
15534 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15535 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015536 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015537
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015538req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
15539rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15540 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
15541 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
15542 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
15543 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
15544 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
15545 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
15546 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015547
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015548 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
15549 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
15550 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
15551 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
15552 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
15553 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015555 ACL derivatives :
15556 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015558 Example :
15559 listen tse-farm
15560 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
15561 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
15562 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15563 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
15564 # apply RDP cookie persistence
15565 persist rdp-cookie
15566 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
15567 # This is only useful makes sense if
15568 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
15569 stick-table type string size 204800
15570 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
15571 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
15572 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015573
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015574 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
15575 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015576
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015577req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
15578rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
15579 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
15580 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
15581 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
15582 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015583
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015584 ACL derivatives :
15585 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015586
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015587req.ssl_alpn : string
15588 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
15589 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
15590 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
15591 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
15592 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
15593 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015594 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015595
15596 Examples :
15597 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15598 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15599 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015600 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015601 default_backend bk_default
15602
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015603req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
15604 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
15605 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015606 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
15607 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
15608 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
15609 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
15610 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015611
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015612req.ssl_hello_type : integer
15613req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15614 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15615 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
15616 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15617 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15618 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
15619 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15620 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015622req.ssl_sni : string
15623req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
15624 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
15625 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
15626 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
15627 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15628 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15629 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
15630 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
15631 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
15632 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
15633 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
15634 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
15635 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015636
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015637 ACL derivatives :
15638 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015640 Examples :
15641 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15642 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15643 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
15644 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
15645 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015646
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053015647req.ssl_st_ext : integer
15648 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
15649 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
15650 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
15651 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
15652 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
15653 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
15654 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
15655 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
15656 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
15657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015658req.ssl_ver : integer
15659req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
15660 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
15661 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
15662 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
15663 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
15664 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15665 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15666 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015667 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015668 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015670 ACL derivatives :
15671 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015672
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020015673res.len : integer
15674 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15675 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15676 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15677 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15678 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15679 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15680 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
15681 content inspection.
15682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015683res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15684 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015685 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15686 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15687 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15688 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015689
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015690res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15691 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15692 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15693 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
15694 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015696 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015697
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020015698res.ssl_hello_type : integer
15699rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15700 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15701 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
15702 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15703 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15704 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
15705 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15706 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
15707
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015708wait_end : boolean
15709 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
15710 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015711 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015712 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
15713 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015714 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015715 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
15716 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015717
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015718 Examples :
15719 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
15720 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
15721 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015723 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
15724 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15725 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
15726 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
15727 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
15728 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
15729 tcp-request content reject
15730
15731
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200157327.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015733--------------------------------------
15734
15735It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
15736This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
15737data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
15738its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
15739HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
15740content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
15741to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
15742more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
15743response are indexed.
15744
15745base : string
15746 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
15747 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
15748 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
15749 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
15750 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
15751 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
15752 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
15753 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
15754
15755 ACL derivatives :
15756 base : exact string match
15757 base_beg : prefix match
15758 base_dir : subdir match
15759 base_dom : domain match
15760 base_end : suffix match
15761 base_len : length match
15762 base_reg : regex match
15763 base_sub : substring match
15764
15765base32 : integer
15766 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
15767 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
15768 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015769 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
15770 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
15771 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015772
15773base32+src : binary
15774 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
15775 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
15776 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
15777 per-URL counters.
15778
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015779capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
15780 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
15781 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15782 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
15783
15784capture.req.method : string
15785 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
15786 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
15787 because it's allocated.
15788
15789capture.req.uri : string
15790 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
15791 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
15792 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
15793 allocated.
15794
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015795capture.req.ver : string
15796 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15797 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
15798 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
15799
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015800capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
15801 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
15802 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15803 The first entry is an index of 0.
15804 See also: "capture response header"
15805
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015806capture.res.ver : string
15807 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15808 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
15809 persistent flag.
15810
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015811req.body : binary
15812 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
15813 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15814 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
15815 the first chunk is analyzed.
15816
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020015817req.body_param([<name>) : string
15818 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
15819 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
15820 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
15821 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
15822 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
15823 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
15824 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
15825 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
15826 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
15827 given.
15828
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015829req.body_len : integer
15830 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
15831 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
15832 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15833 "option http-buffer-request".
15834
15835req.body_size : integer
15836 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
15837 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
15838 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
15839 that the request body has been buffered made available using
15840 "option http-buffer-request".
15841
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015842req.cook([<name>]) : string
15843cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15844 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15845 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
15846 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
15847 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
15848 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
15849 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
15850 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
15851 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
15852
15853 ACL derivatives :
15854 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
15855 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
15856 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
15857 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
15858 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
15859 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
15860 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
15861 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015863req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15864cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15865 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
15866 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015867
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015868req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
15869cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15870 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15871 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
15872 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
15873 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015875cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15876 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15877 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
15878 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
15879 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020015880 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015881 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
15882 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
15883 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
15884 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015886hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15887 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
15888 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
15889 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
15890 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015891 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015893req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
15894 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15895 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15896 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15897 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15898 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15899 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
15900 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
15901 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015903req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15904 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15905 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15906 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
15907 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015908
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015909req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15910 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15911 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15912 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15913 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15914 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15915 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
15916 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
15917 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000015918 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015919 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015920 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015921
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015922 ACL derivatives :
15923 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
15924 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
15925 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
15926 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
15927 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
15928 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
15929 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
15930 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
15931
15932req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15933hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
15934 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15935 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
15936 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
15937 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
15938 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
15939 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
15940 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
15941 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
15942 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
15943
15944req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
15945hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
15946 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
15947 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
15948 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
15949 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15950 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015951 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015952 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
15953 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
15954
15955req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
15956hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
15957 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
15958 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
15959 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
15960 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15961 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15962 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15963 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
15964
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010015965
15966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015967http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
15968 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
15969 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
15970 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15971 basic auth is supported.
15972
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015973http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
15974 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
15975 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
15976 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
15977 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015978 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15979 basic auth is supported.
15980
15981 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015982 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
15983 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
15984 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
15985 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015986
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020015987http_auth_pass : string
15988 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
15989 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
15990 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
15991
15992http_auth_type : string
15993 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
15994 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
15995 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
15996
15997http_auth_user : string
15998 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
15999 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
16000 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
16001
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016002http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016003 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16004 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016005 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16006 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016007
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016008method : integer + string
16009 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16010 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16011 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16012 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16013 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16014 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16015 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016017 ACL derivatives :
16018 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016019
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016020 Example :
16021 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16022 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16023 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016024
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016025path : string
16026 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16027 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16028 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16029 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16030 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016031 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016032 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016034 ACL derivatives :
16035 path : exact string match
16036 path_beg : prefix match
16037 path_dir : subdir match
16038 path_dom : domain match
16039 path_end : suffix match
16040 path_len : length match
16041 path_reg : regex match
16042 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016043
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016044query : string
16045 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16046 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16047 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16048 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016049 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016050 which stops before the question mark.
16051
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016052req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16053 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16054 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16055 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16056 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16057
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016058req.ver : string
16059req_ver : string (deprecated)
16060 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16061 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16062 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016063
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016064 ACL derivatives :
16065 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016067res.comp : boolean
16068 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16069 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16070 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016071
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016072res.comp_algo : string
16073 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16074 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16075 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016077res.cook([<name>]) : string
16078scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16079 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16080 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16081 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016082
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016083 ACL derivatives :
16084 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016085
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016086res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16087scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16088 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16089 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16090 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016091
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016092res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16093scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16094 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16095 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16096 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016097
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016098res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16099 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16100 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16101 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16102 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16103 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16104 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16105 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16106 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16107 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016109res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16110 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16111 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16112 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16113 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16114 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016116res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16117shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16118 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16119 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16120 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16121 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16122 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16123 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16124 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16125 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016126
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016127 ACL derivatives :
16128 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16129 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16130 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16131 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16132 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16133 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16134 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16135 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16136
16137res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16138shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16139 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16140 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16141 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16142 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16143 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016144
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016145res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16146shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16147 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16148 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16149 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16150 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16151 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16152 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016153
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016154res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16155 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16156 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16157 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16158 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016160res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16161shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16162 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16163 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16164 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16165 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16166 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16167 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016168
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016169res.ver : string
16170resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16171 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16172 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016174 ACL derivatives :
16175 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016177set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16178 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16179 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016180 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016181 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016182
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016183 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16184 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016185
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016186status : integer
16187 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16188 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16189 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016190
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016191unique-id : string
16192 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16193 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16194 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16195 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16196 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16197 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16198
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016199url : string
16200 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16201 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16202 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16203 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16204 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16205 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16206 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016208 ACL derivatives :
16209 url : exact string match
16210 url_beg : prefix match
16211 url_dir : subdir match
16212 url_dom : domain match
16213 url_end : suffix match
16214 url_len : length match
16215 url_reg : regex match
16216 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016218url_ip : ip
16219 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16220 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16221 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16222 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16223 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16224 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16225 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016227url_port : integer
16228 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16229 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16230 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16231 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016232
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016233urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16234url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016235 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16236 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016237 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16238 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16239 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16240 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016241 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16242 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016243 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16244 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016246 ACL derivatives :
16247 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16248 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16249 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16250 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16251 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16252 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16253 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16254 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016255
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016256
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016257 Example :
16258 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16259 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16260 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16261 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016262
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016263urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016264 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16265 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16266 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016267
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016268url32 : integer
16269 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16270 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16271 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16272 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16273 is an unsigned integer.
16274
16275url32+src : binary
16276 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16277 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16278 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16279
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200162817.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016282---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016283
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016284Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16285every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016286order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016287
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016288ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16289---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016290FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016291HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016292HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16293HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016294HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16295HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16296HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16297HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16298LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016299METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016300METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016301METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16302METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16303METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16304METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016305METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016306METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016307RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016308REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016309TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016310WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16311---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016312
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016313
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163148. Logging
16315----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016316
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016317One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16318provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16319very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16320provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16321state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016322to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016323headers.
16324
16325In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16326about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16327send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16328
16329 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16330 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16331 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16332 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16333 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016334 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016335 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016336
16337The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16338allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16339as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16340while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16341real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16342delay.
16343
16344
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163458.1. Log levels
16346---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016347
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016348TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016349source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016350HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16351in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
16352track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
16353syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
16354about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016355
16356
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163578.2. Log formats
16358----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016359
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016360HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016361and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
16362slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
16363options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016364
16365 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
16366 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
16367 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
16368 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
16369 extents.
16370
16371 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
16372 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
16373 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
16374 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
16375 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
16376
16377 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
16378 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
16379 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
16380 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
16381 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
16382
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020016383 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
16384 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
16385 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
16386 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
16387
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016388 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
16389
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016390Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
16391specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
16392field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
16393servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
16394always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
16395identifier.
16396
16397Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
16398 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
16399 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
16400 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
16401 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
16402
16403
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164048.2.1. Default log format
16405-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016406
16407This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
16408as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
16409format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
16410
16411 Example :
16412 listen www
16413 mode http
16414 log global
16415 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16416
16417 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
16418 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
16419 (www/HTTP)
16420
16421 Field Format Extract from the example above
16422 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
16423 2 'Connect from' Connect from
16424 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
16425 4 'to' to
16426 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
16427 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
16428
16429Detailed fields description :
16430 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
16431 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
16432 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
16433 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
16434 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16435 and processed the connection.
16436 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
16437
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016438In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
16439"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
16440connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
16441
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016442It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
16443will eventually disappear.
16444
16445
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164468.2.2. TCP log format
16447---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016448
16449The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
16450is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
16451information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
16452counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
16453emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
16454environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
16455the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
16456sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016457specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
16458not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
16459fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
16460marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016461
16462 Example :
16463 frontend fnt
16464 mode tcp
16465 option tcplog
16466 log global
16467 default_backend bck
16468
16469 backend bck
16470 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16471
16472 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
16473 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
16474 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
16475
16476 Field Format Extract from the example above
16477 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
16478 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
16479 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
16480 4 frontend_name fnt
16481 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
16482 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
16483 7 bytes_read* 212
16484 8 termination_state --
16485 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
16486 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16487
16488Detailed fields description :
16489 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016490 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16491 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16492 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016493 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016494 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016495 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016496
16497 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016498 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16499 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16500 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016501
16502 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
16503 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
16504 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016505 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
16506 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
16507 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
16508 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016509
16510 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16511 and processed the connection.
16512
16513 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16514 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16515 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
16516 applications.
16517
16518 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16519 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16520 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16521 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
16522 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
16523
16524 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16525 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
16526 See "Timers" below for more details.
16527
16528 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16529 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
16530 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
16531 "Timers" below for more details.
16532
16533 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016534 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016535 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
16536 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
16537 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
16538 details.
16539
16540 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
16541 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
16542 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
16543 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
16544 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
16545
16546 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16547 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16548 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
16549 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
16550 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
16551 for more details.
16552
16553 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016554 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016555 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
16556 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
16557 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016558 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016559
16560 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16561 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16562 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16563 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16564 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16565 caused by a denial of service attack.
16566
16567 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16568 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16569 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16570 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16571 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16572 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16573 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16574 denial of service attack.
16575
16576 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16577 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16578 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16579 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16580 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16581 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16582 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16583 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
16584 be processed than on other servers.
16585
16586 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16587 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16588 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16589 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16590 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16591 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16592 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16593 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16594 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16595 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16596 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16597 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16598 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16599
16600 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16601 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16602 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16603 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16604 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16605 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016606 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016607 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16608
16609 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16610 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16611 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16612 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16613 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16614 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016615 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016616 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16617 occurs.
16618
16619
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166208.2.3. HTTP log format
16621----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016622
16623The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
16624is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
16625the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
16626are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
16627emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
16628generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
16629"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
16630which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016631frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
16632is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016633
16634Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
16635slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
16636with a star ('*') after the field name below.
16637
16638 Example :
16639 frontend http-in
16640 mode http
16641 option httplog
16642 log global
16643 default_backend bck
16644
16645 backend static
16646 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16647
16648 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
16649 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
16650 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016651 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016652
16653 Field Format Extract from the example above
16654 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
16655 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016656 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016657 4 frontend_name http-in
16658 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016659 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016660 7 status_code 200
16661 8 bytes_read* 2750
16662 9 captured_request_cookie -
16663 10 captured_response_cookie -
16664 11 termination_state ----
16665 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
16666 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16667 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
16668 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
16669 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016670
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016671Detailed fields description :
16672 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016673 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16674 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16675 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016676 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016677 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016678 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016679
16680 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016681 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16682 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16683 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016684
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016685 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
16686 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016687
16688 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16689 and processed the connection.
16690
16691 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16692 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16693 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
16694
16695 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16696 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16697 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16698 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
16699 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
16700 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
16701
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016702 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
16703 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
16704 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016705 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016706 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
16707 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016708 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
16709 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016710
16711 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16712 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016713 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016714
16715 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16716 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016717 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
16718 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016719
16720 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
16721 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
16722 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
16723 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
16724 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016725 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
16726 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016727
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016728 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
16729 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
16730 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
16731 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
16732 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
16733 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
16734 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016735 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016736
16737 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
16738 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
16739 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
16740
16741 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
16742 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016743 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016744 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
16745 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
16746 overflowing.
16747
16748 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
16749 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
16750 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
16751 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
16752 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
16753 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
16754 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
16755 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16756
16757 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
16758 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
16759 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
16760 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
16761 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
16762 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
16763 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
16764 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16765
16766 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16767 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16768 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
16769 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
16770 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
16771 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
16772 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
16773
16774 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016775 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016776 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
16777 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
16778 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016779 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016780 system.
16781
16782 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16783 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16784 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16785 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16786 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16787 caused by a denial of service attack.
16788
16789 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16790 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16791 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16792 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16793 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16794 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16795 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16796 denial of service attack.
16797
16798 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16799 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16800 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16801 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16802 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16803 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16804 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16805 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
16806 processed than on other servers.
16807
16808 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16809 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16810 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16811 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16812 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16813 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16814 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16815 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16816 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16817 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16818 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16819 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16820 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16821
16822 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16823 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16824 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16825 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16826 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16827 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016828 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016829 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16830
16831 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16832 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16833 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16834 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16835 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16836 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016837 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016838 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16839 occurs.
16840
16841 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
16842 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
16843 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
16844 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
16845 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
16846 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
16847 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
16848 cookies" below for more details.
16849
16850 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
16851 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
16852 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
16853 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
16854 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
16855 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
16856 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
16857 and cookies" below for more details.
16858
16859 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
16860 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
16861 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
16862 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
16863 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
16864 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
16865 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
16866 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
16867
16868
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200168698.2.4. Custom log format
16870------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016871
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016872The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016873mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016874
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016875HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016876Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
16877separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
16878prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
16879
16880Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
16881variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016882("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016883
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016884If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020016885as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016886less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
16887the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
16888
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016889Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016890In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010016891in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016892
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016893Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
16894'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
16895https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
16896such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
16897
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016898Flags are :
16899 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016900 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016901 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
16902 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016903
16904 Example:
16905
16906 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
16907 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
16908
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016909 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
16910
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016911At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
16912
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016913 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
16914 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016915
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016916the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016917
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016918 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
16919 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
16920 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016921
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016922and the default TCP format is defined this way :
16923
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016924 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
16925 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016926
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016927Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
16928
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016929 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016930 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016931 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
16932 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
16933 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016934 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
16935 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
16936 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016937 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016938 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
16939 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000016940 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016941 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
16942 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010016943 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020016944 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016945 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016946 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016947 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020016948 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080016949 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016950 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
16951 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
16952 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
16953 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
16954 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016955 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016956 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
16957 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016958 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016959 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
16960 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016961 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16962 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
16963 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016964 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016965 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
16966 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016967 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016968 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16969 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
16970 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020016971 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020016972 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016973 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
16974 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
16975 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
16976 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020016977 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016978 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016979 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016980 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010016981 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016982 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016983 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
16984 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
16985 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016986 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016987 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
16988 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016989 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016990 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
16991 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020016992 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016993 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016994 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016995 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016996
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016997 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016998
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010016999
170008.2.5. Error log format
17001-----------------------
17002
17003When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17004protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17005By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17006"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017007will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017008logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17009
17010The format looks like this :
17011
17012 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17013 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17014 Connection error during SSL handshake
17015
17016 Field Format Extract from the example above
17017 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17018 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17019 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17020 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17021 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17022
17023These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17024failures.
17025
17026
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170278.3. Advanced logging options
17028-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017029
17030Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17031just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17032options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17033for more information about their usage.
17034
17035
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170368.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17037------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017038
17039It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17040haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17041commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17042monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17043ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17044
17045 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17046 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17047 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17048 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17049
17050 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17051 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17052 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017053 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017054 such as other load-balancers.
17055
17056 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17057 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17058 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17059
17060
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170618.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17062----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017063
17064The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17065what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17066or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017067"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017068just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17069log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17070after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17071is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17072with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17073with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17074
17075
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170768.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17077------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017078
17079Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17080for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17081"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17082retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17083raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17084a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17085file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17086you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17087"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17088
17089
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170908.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17091--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017092
17093Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17094multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17095them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17096"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17097logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17098error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17099and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17100too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17101useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17102alternative.
17103
17104
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171058.4. Timing events
17106------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017107
17108Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17109reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17110the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17111frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017112mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17113addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17114
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017115Timings events in HTTP mode:
17116
17117 first request 2nd request
17118 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17119 t tr t tr ...
17120 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17121 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17122 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17123 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17124 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17125
17126Timings events in TCP mode:
17127
17128 TCP session
17129 |<----------------->|
17130 t t
17131 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17132 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17133 |<------ Tt ------->|
17134
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017135 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017136 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017137 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17138 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17139 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017140 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017141 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17142 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17143 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17144 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017145
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017146 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17147 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17148 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017149 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17150 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17151 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17152 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17153 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17154 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017155
17156 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17157 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17158 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17159 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17160 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17161 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17162 request typed by hand during a test.
17163
17164 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17165 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017166 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017167 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17168 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17169 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17170 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017171
17172 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17173 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17174 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17175 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17176 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17177
17178 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17179 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17180 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17181 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17182 connection never established.
17183
17184 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17185 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17186 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17187 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17188 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17189 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17190 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17191 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17192 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17193 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17194 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17195
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017196 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17197 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17198 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17199 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17200 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17201 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17202
17203 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17204
17205 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17206 "Ta" can never be negative.
17207
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017208 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17209 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017210 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17211 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017212 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017213
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017214 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017215
17216 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017217 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17218 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017219
17220These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17221protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17222that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017223due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17224"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17225that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017226
17227Most common cases :
17228
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017229 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17230 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17231 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17232 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17233 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17234 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17235 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17236 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17237 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17238 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17239 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017240 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017241
17242 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17243 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17244 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17245 of ms on remote networks.
17246
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017247 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17248 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17249 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017250
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017251 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17252 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17253 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17254 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17255 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17256 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17257 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17258 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17259 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017260
17261Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17262
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017263 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017264 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017265 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017266
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017267 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017268 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17269 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17270
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017271 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017272 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17273 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17274 flags.
17275
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017276 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17277 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017278 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17279 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17280 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17281 the client connection was maintained open.
17282
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017283 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017284 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017285 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017286 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17287
17288
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172898.5. Session state at disconnection
17290-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017291
17292TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17293"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
172942-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17295each of which has a special meaning :
17296
17297 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17298 session to terminate :
17299
17300 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17301
17302 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17303 server explicitly refused it.
17304
17305 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17306 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17307 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17308 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017309 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017310
17311 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17312 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017313
17314 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17315 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17316 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17317 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17318 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17319
17320 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17321 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17322 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17323 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17324 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17325
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017326 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17327 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17328
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017329 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17330 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17331 backup connections when going up.
17332
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017333 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17334
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017335 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17336 send or receive data.
17337
17338 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17339 send or receive data.
17340
17341 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17342 with nothing left in the buffers.
17343
17344 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17345
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017346 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017347 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17348
17349 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17350 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17351 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
17352 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
17353 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
17354
17355 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
17356 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
17357
17358 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
17359 server (HTTP only).
17360
17361 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
17362
17363 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
17364 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
17365 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
17366
17367 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
17368 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
17369 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
17370
17371 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
17372
17373 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
17374 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
17375
17376 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
17377 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
17378 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
17379
17380 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
17381 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020017382 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
17383 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017384
17385 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
17386 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
17387 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
17388 another server.
17389
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017390 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017391 server.
17392
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017393 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
17394 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
17395 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
17396 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17397
17398 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
17399 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
17400 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
17401 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17402
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020017403 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
17404 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
17405 "use-server" rule).
17406
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017407 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17408
17409 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
17410 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
17411
17412 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
17413
17414 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
17415 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
17416 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
17417
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017418 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
17419 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017420 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017421 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
17422 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
17423
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017424 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
17425
17426 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
17427 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
17428
17429 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
17430
17431 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17432
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017433The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
17434was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017435helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
17436starvation, attacks, etc...
17437
17438The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
17439alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
17440easier finding and understanding.
17441
17442 Flags Reason
17443
17444 -- Normal termination.
17445
17446 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
17447 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
17448 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
17449 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
17450
17451 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
17452 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
17453 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
17454 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
17455 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
17456 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017457
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017458 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17459 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017460 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017461
17462 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
17463 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
17464 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
17465
17466 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
17467 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
17468 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
17469 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
17470 the server takes too long to respond.
17471
17472 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
17473 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
17474 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
17475 long a time to respond.
17476
17477 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
17478 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
17479 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
17480 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017481 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
17482 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017483
17484 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
17485 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
17486 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
17487 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
17488 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020017489 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017490 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
17491 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
17492 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
17493 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
17494 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
17495 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
17496 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
17497 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017498 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017499 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
17500 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
17501 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017502
17503 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
17504 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017505 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
17506 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
17507 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
17508 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017509
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017510 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
17511 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
17512
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017513 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017514 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
17515 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017516 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017517 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
17518 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
17519
17520 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
17521 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
17522 503 or 504 here.
17523
17524 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
17525 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
17526 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
17527 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
17528 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
17529
17530 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17531 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017532 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017533 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
17534 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
17535
17536 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
17537 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
17538 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
17539 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
17540 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
17541 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
17542 between haproxy and the server.
17543
17544 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
17545 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
17546 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
17547 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
17548 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
17549 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
17550 solution is to fix the application.
17551
17552 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
17553 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
17554 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
17555 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
17556 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
17557 external attacks.
17558
17559 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
17560 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017561 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017562 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
17563 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
17564
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017565 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
17566 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
17567 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017568 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020017569 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017570
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017571 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
17572 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
17573 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
17574 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017575 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
17576 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
17577 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
17578 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
17579 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017580
17581 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
17582 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
17583 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
17584 returned an HTTP 403 error.
17585
17586 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
17587 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
17588 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
17589 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
17590
17591 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
17592 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
17593 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
17594 only be solved by proper system tuning.
17595
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017596The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
17597persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
17598important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
17599re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
17600
17601 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
17602
17603 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17604 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
17605 set on a GET request.
17606
17607 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
17608 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017609 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017610 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
17611
17612 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
17613 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
17614 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
17615
17616 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17617 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
17618 already got a cookie.
17619
17620 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17621 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
17622 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
17623 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
17624 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
17625
17626 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17627 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17628 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17629
17630 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
17631 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17632 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17633
17634 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
17635 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
17636
17637 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
17638 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
17639 then advertised in the response.
17640
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017641
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176428.6. Non-printable characters
17643-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017644
17645In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
17646consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
17647converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
17648prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
17649being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
17650escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
17651is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
17652'}' when logging headers.
17653
17654Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
17655issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
17656containing spaces is "User-Agent".
17657
17658Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
17659the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
17660performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
17661
17662
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176638.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
17664---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017665
17666Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
17667achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017668section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017669cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
17670the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
17671the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017672locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017673not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
17674user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
17675a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
17676wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
17677
17678 Examples :
17679 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
17680 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
17681
17682 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
17683 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
17684
17685
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176868.8. Capturing HTTP headers
17687---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017688
17689Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
17690proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
17691the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
17692server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
17693
17694Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
17695response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017696section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017697
17698It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017699time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
17700appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017701are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
17702and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
17703follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
17704request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
17705in the logs.
17706
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017707As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
17708frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
17709an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
17710
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017711 Example :
17712 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
17713 listen proxy-out
17714 mode http
17715 option httplog
17716 option logasap
17717 log global
17718 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
17719
17720 # log the name of the virtual server
17721 capture request header Host len 20
17722
17723 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
17724 capture request header Content-Length len 10
17725
17726 # log the beginning of the referrer
17727 capture request header Referer len 20
17728
17729 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
17730 capture response header Server len 20
17731
17732 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
17733 capture response header Content-Length len 10
17734
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017735 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017736 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
17737
17738 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
17739 capture response header Via len 20
17740
17741 # log the URL location during a redirection
17742 capture response header Location len 20
17743
17744 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
17745 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
17746 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17747 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
17748 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
17749
17750 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17751 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17752 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17753 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017754 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017755
17756 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17757 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17758 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17759 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
17760 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017761 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017762
17763
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177648.9. Examples of logs
17765---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017766
17767These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
17768them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
17769reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
17770
17771 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
17772 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17773 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17774
17775 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
17776 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
17777
17778 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
17779 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
17780 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17781
17782 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
17783 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
17784
17785 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
17786 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17787 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
17788
17789 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017790 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017791 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
17792 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
17793
17794 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
17795 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
17796 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
17797
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020017798 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
17799 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
17800 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
17801 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
17802 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
17803 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017804
17805 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017806 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017807
17808 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
17809 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
17810 Nothing was sent to any server.
17811
17812 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
17813 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
17814
17815 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
17816 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017817 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017818 send a 408 return code to the client.
17819
17820 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
17821 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
17822
17823 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
17824 5 seconds ("c----").
17825
17826 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
17827 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017828 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017829
17830 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017831 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017832 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
17833 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
17834 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
17835 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
17836 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017837
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020017838
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200178399. Supported filters
17840--------------------
17841
17842Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
17843accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
17844unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
17845
17846See also : "filter"
17847
178489.1. Trace
17849----------
17850
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017851filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017852
17853 Arguments:
17854 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
17855 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
17856
17857 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
17858 the client and the server. By default, this filter
17859 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
17860 only parses a random amount of the available data.
17861
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017862 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017863 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
17864 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
17865 amount of the parsed data.
17866
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017867 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017868
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017869This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
17870callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
17871information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
17872filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
17873
17874Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
17875tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
17876a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
17877
17878
178799.2. HTTP compression
17880---------------------
17881
17882filter compression
17883
17884The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
17885keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020017886when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
17887fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
17888done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
17889explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
17890filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
17891listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
17892order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017893
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020017894See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
17895 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017896
17897
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200178989.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
17899--------------------------------------------
17900
17901filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
17902
17903 Arguments :
17904
17905 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
17906 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
17907 parsed.
17908
17909 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
17910 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
17911 part must be placed in its own scope.
17912
17913The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
17914external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017915streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017916exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
17917also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
17918
17919SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
17920the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
17921
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017922For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017923"doc/SPOE.txt".
17924
17925Important note:
17926 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
17927 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
17928
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100179299.4. Cache
17930----------
17931
17932filter cache <name>
17933
17934 Arguments :
17935
17936 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
17937
17938The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
17939"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017940cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020017941other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
17942case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
17943is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
17944filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017945listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
17946order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010017947
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020017948See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
17949 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
17950
17951
179529.5. Fcgi-app
17953-------------
17954
17955filter fcg-app <name>
17956
17957 Arguments :
17958
17959 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
17960
17961The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
17962request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
17963reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
17964used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
17965implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
17966used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
17967fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
17968used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
17969order.
17970
17971See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
17972 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
17973
17974
1797510. FastCGI applications
17976-------------------------
17977
17978HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
17979feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
17980the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
17981FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
17982servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
17983FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
17984backend.
17985
17986HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
17987application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
17988connection.
17989
1799010.1. Setup
17991-----------
17992
1799310.1.1. Fcgi-app section
17994--------------------------
17995
17996fcgi-app <name>
17997 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
17998 document root must be defined.
17999
18000acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
18001 Declare or complete an access list.
18002
18003 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
18004 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
18005 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
18006 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
18007 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
18008
18009docroot <path>
18010 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
18011 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
18012 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
18013
18014index <script-name>
18015 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
18016 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
18017 is an optional setting.
18018
18019 Example :
18020 index index.php
18021
18022log-stderr global
18023log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
18024 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
18025 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
18026
18027 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
18028 default STDERR messages are ignored.
18029
18030pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
18031 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
18032 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
18033 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
18034
18035 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
18036 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
18037 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
18038 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
18039
18040 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
18041 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
18042
18043path-info <regex>
18044 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info
18045 from the URI. Thus, <regex> should have two captures: the first one to
18046 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. It is an
18047 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
18048 URI. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not filled.
18049
18050 Example :
18051 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
18052
18053option get-values
18054no option get-values
18055 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
18056
18057 HAproxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
18058 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
18059
18060 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
18061 application will accept.
18062
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020018063 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
18064 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018065
18066 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
18067 the connexion immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
18068 option is disabled.
18069
18070 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
18071 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
18072 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
18073 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
18074 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
18075 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
18076
18077option keep-conn
18078no option keep-conn
18079 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
18080 sending a response.
18081
18082 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
18083 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
18084
18085option max-reqs <reqs>
18086 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
18087 accept.
18088
18089 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
18090 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
18091 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
18092 to 1.
18093
18094option mpxs-conns
18095no option mpxs-conns
18096 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
18097
18098 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
18099 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
18100
18101set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
18102 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
18103 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
18104 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
18105 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
18106
18107 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
18108 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
18109 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
18110
18111 Example :
18112 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
18113 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
18114
18115 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
18116
18117
1811810.1.2. Proxy section
18119---------------------
18120
18121use-fcgi-app <name>
18122 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
18123
18124 Arguments :
18125 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
18126
18127 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
18128 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
18129 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
18130 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
18131 application may be defined at a time per backend.
18132
18133 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
18134 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
18135 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
18136 application are evaluated.
18137
18138
1813910.1.3. Example
18140---------------
18141
18142 frontend front-http
18143 mode http
18144 bind *:80
18145 bind *:
18146
18147 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
18148 default_backend back-static
18149
18150 backend back-static
18151 mode http
18152 server www A.B.C.D:80
18153
18154 backend back-dynamic
18155 mode http
18156 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
18157 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
18158
18159 fcgi-app php-fpm
18160 log-stderr global
18161 option keep-conn
18162
18163 docroot /var/www/my-app
18164 index index.php
18165 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
18166
18167
1816810.2. Default parameters
18169------------------------
18170
18171A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
18172the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
18173scipt. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
18174applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
18175
18176 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18177 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
18178 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
18179 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
18180 | | |
18181 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18182 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
18183 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
18184 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
18185 | | application. |
18186 | | |
18187 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18188 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
18189 | | the request. It may not be set. |
18190 | | |
18191 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18192 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
18193 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
18194 | | the application's configuration. |
18195 | | |
18196 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18197 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
18198 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
18199 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
18200 | | |
18201 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18202 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
18203 | | following the part that identifies the script |
18204 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
18205 | | be defined. |
18206 | | |
18207 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18208 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
18209 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
18210 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
18211 | | is not set too. |
18212 | | |
18213 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18214 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
18215 | | set. |
18216 | | |
18217 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18218 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
18219 | | the request. |
18220 | | |
18221 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18222 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
18223 | | client as part of user authentication. |
18224 | | |
18225 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18226 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
18227 | | script to process the request. |
18228 | | |
18229 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18230 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
18231 | | |
18232 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18233 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
18234 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
18235 | | |
18236 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18237 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
18238 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
18239 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
18240 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
18241 | | |
18242 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18243 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
18244 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
18245 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
18246 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
18247 | | side. |
18248 | | |
18249 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18250 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
18251 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
18252 | | connected to. |
18253 | | |
18254 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18255 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
18256 | | |
18257 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18258 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
18259 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
18260 | | |
18261 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18262
18263
1826410.3. Limitations
18265------------------
18266
18267The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
18268way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
18269during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
18270establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
18271application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
18272or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
18273message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
18274these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
18275and HTTP servers under the same backend.
18276
18277Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
18278request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
18279requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
18280
18281About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
18282into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
18283fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
18284"http-request" ones.
18285
18286Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
18287FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
18288processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
18289must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
18290here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018291
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018292/*
18293 * Local variables:
18294 * fill-column: 79
18295 * End:
18296 */